24738 lines
814 KiB
Go
24738 lines
814 KiB
Go
// Code generated by private/model/cli/gen-api/main.go. DO NOT EDIT.
|
|
|
|
package s3
|
|
|
|
import (
|
|
"bytes"
|
|
"fmt"
|
|
"io"
|
|
"sync"
|
|
"sync/atomic"
|
|
"time"
|
|
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awsutil"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/client"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/request"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol/eventstream"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol/eventstream/eventstreamapi"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol/rest"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol/restxml"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const opAbortMultipartUpload = "AbortMultipartUpload"
|
|
|
|
// AbortMultipartUploadRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the AbortMultipartUpload operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See AbortMultipartUpload for more information on using the AbortMultipartUpload
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the AbortMultipartUploadRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.AbortMultipartUploadRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/AbortMultipartUpload
|
|
func (c *S3) AbortMultipartUploadRequest(input *AbortMultipartUploadInput) (req *request.Request, output *AbortMultipartUploadOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opAbortMultipartUpload,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &AbortMultipartUploadInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &AbortMultipartUploadOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// AbortMultipartUpload API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Aborts a multipart upload.
|
|
//
|
|
// To verify that all parts have been removed, so you don't get charged for
|
|
// the part storage, you should call the List Parts operation and ensure the
|
|
// parts list is empty.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation AbortMultipartUpload for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeNoSuchUpload "NoSuchUpload"
|
|
// The specified multipart upload does not exist.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/AbortMultipartUpload
|
|
func (c *S3) AbortMultipartUpload(input *AbortMultipartUploadInput) (*AbortMultipartUploadOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.AbortMultipartUploadRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// AbortMultipartUploadWithContext is the same as AbortMultipartUpload with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See AbortMultipartUpload for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) AbortMultipartUploadWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AbortMultipartUploadInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AbortMultipartUploadOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.AbortMultipartUploadRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCompleteMultipartUpload = "CompleteMultipartUpload"
|
|
|
|
// CompleteMultipartUploadRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CompleteMultipartUpload operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CompleteMultipartUpload for more information on using the CompleteMultipartUpload
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CompleteMultipartUploadRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CompleteMultipartUploadRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/CompleteMultipartUpload
|
|
func (c *S3) CompleteMultipartUploadRequest(input *CompleteMultipartUploadInput) (req *request.Request, output *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCompleteMultipartUpload,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CompleteMultipartUploadInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CompleteMultipartUploadOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CompleteMultipartUpload API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Completes a multipart upload by assembling previously uploaded parts.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation CompleteMultipartUpload for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/CompleteMultipartUpload
|
|
func (c *S3) CompleteMultipartUpload(input *CompleteMultipartUploadInput) (*CompleteMultipartUploadOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CompleteMultipartUploadRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CompleteMultipartUploadWithContext is the same as CompleteMultipartUpload with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CompleteMultipartUpload for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) CompleteMultipartUploadWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CompleteMultipartUploadInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CompleteMultipartUploadOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CompleteMultipartUploadRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCopyObject = "CopyObject"
|
|
|
|
// CopyObjectRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CopyObject operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CopyObject for more information on using the CopyObject
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CopyObjectRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CopyObjectRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/CopyObject
|
|
func (c *S3) CopyObjectRequest(input *CopyObjectInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyObjectOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCopyObject,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CopyObjectInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CopyObjectOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CopyObject API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a copy of an object that is already stored in Amazon S3.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation CopyObject for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeObjectNotInActiveTierError "ObjectNotInActiveTierError"
|
|
// The source object of the COPY operation is not in the active tier and is
|
|
// only stored in Amazon Glacier.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/CopyObject
|
|
func (c *S3) CopyObject(input *CopyObjectInput) (*CopyObjectOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CopyObjectRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CopyObjectWithContext is the same as CopyObject with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CopyObject for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) CopyObjectWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyObjectInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyObjectOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CopyObjectRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateBucket = "CreateBucket"
|
|
|
|
// CreateBucketRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateBucket operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateBucket for more information on using the CreateBucket
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateBucketRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateBucketRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/CreateBucket
|
|
func (c *S3) CreateBucketRequest(input *CreateBucketInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateBucketOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateBucket,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateBucketInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateBucketOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateBucket API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a new bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation CreateBucket for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBucketAlreadyExists "BucketAlreadyExists"
|
|
// The requested bucket name is not available. The bucket namespace is shared
|
|
// by all users of the system. Please select a different name and try again.
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBucketAlreadyOwnedByYou "BucketAlreadyOwnedByYou"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/CreateBucket
|
|
func (c *S3) CreateBucket(input *CreateBucketInput) (*CreateBucketOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateBucketRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateBucketWithContext is the same as CreateBucket with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateBucket for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) CreateBucketWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateBucketInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateBucketOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateBucketRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateMultipartUpload = "CreateMultipartUpload"
|
|
|
|
// CreateMultipartUploadRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateMultipartUpload operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateMultipartUpload for more information on using the CreateMultipartUpload
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateMultipartUploadRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateMultipartUploadRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/CreateMultipartUpload
|
|
func (c *S3) CreateMultipartUploadRequest(input *CreateMultipartUploadInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateMultipartUploadOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateMultipartUpload,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}?uploads",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateMultipartUploadInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateMultipartUploadOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateMultipartUpload API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Initiates a multipart upload and returns an upload ID.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: After you initiate multipart upload and upload one or more parts, you
|
|
// must either complete or abort multipart upload in order to stop getting charged
|
|
// for storage of the uploaded parts. Only after you either complete or abort
|
|
// multipart upload, Amazon S3 frees up the parts storage and stops charging
|
|
// you for the parts storage.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation CreateMultipartUpload for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/CreateMultipartUpload
|
|
func (c *S3) CreateMultipartUpload(input *CreateMultipartUploadInput) (*CreateMultipartUploadOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateMultipartUploadRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateMultipartUploadWithContext is the same as CreateMultipartUpload with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateMultipartUpload for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) CreateMultipartUploadWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateMultipartUploadInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateMultipartUploadOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateMultipartUploadRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteBucket = "DeleteBucket"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteBucket operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucket for more information on using the DeleteBucket
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteBucketRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteBucketRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucket
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketRequest(input *DeleteBucketInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteBucketOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteBucket,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteBucketInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteBucketOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucket API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes the bucket. All objects (including all object versions and Delete
|
|
// Markers) in the bucket must be deleted before the bucket itself can be deleted.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteBucket for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucket
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucket(input *DeleteBucketInput) (*DeleteBucketOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketWithContext is the same as DeleteBucket with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucket for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteBucketInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteBucketOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration = "DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration for more information on using the DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest(input *DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?analytics",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes an analytics configuration for the bucket (specified by the analytics
|
|
// configuration ID).
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration(input *DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) (*DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationWithContext is the same as DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteBucketCors = "DeleteBucketCors"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketCorsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteBucketCors operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketCors for more information on using the DeleteBucketCors
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteBucketCorsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteBucketCorsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketCors
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketCorsRequest(input *DeleteBucketCorsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteBucketCorsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteBucketCors,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?cors",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteBucketCorsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteBucketCorsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketCors API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes the CORS configuration information set for the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteBucketCors for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketCors
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketCors(input *DeleteBucketCorsInput) (*DeleteBucketCorsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketCorsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketCorsWithContext is the same as DeleteBucketCors with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketCors for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketCorsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteBucketCorsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteBucketCorsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketCorsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteBucketEncryption = "DeleteBucketEncryption"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketEncryptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteBucketEncryption operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketEncryption for more information on using the DeleteBucketEncryption
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteBucketEncryptionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteBucketEncryptionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketEncryption
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketEncryptionRequest(input *DeleteBucketEncryptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteBucketEncryptionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteBucketEncryption,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?encryption",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteBucketEncryptionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteBucketEncryptionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketEncryption API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes the server-side encryption configuration from the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteBucketEncryption for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketEncryption
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketEncryption(input *DeleteBucketEncryptionInput) (*DeleteBucketEncryptionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketEncryptionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketEncryptionWithContext is the same as DeleteBucketEncryption with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketEncryption for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketEncryptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteBucketEncryptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteBucketEncryptionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketEncryptionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration = "DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration for more information on using the DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest(input *DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?inventory",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes an inventory configuration (identified by the inventory ID) from
|
|
// the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration(input *DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) (*DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationWithContext is the same as DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteBucketLifecycle = "DeleteBucketLifecycle"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketLifecycleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteBucketLifecycle operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketLifecycle for more information on using the DeleteBucketLifecycle
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteBucketLifecycleRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteBucketLifecycleRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketLifecycle
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketLifecycleRequest(input *DeleteBucketLifecycleInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteBucketLifecycleOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteBucketLifecycle,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?lifecycle",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteBucketLifecycleInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteBucketLifecycleOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketLifecycle API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes the lifecycle configuration from the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteBucketLifecycle for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketLifecycle
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketLifecycle(input *DeleteBucketLifecycleInput) (*DeleteBucketLifecycleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketLifecycleRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketLifecycleWithContext is the same as DeleteBucketLifecycle with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketLifecycle for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketLifecycleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteBucketLifecycleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteBucketLifecycleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketLifecycleRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration = "DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration for more information on using the DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest(input *DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?metrics",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes a metrics configuration (specified by the metrics configuration ID)
|
|
// from the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration(input *DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) (*DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationWithContext is the same as DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteBucketPolicy = "DeleteBucketPolicy"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteBucketPolicy operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketPolicy for more information on using the DeleteBucketPolicy
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteBucketPolicyRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteBucketPolicyRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketPolicy
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketPolicyRequest(input *DeleteBucketPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteBucketPolicyOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteBucketPolicy,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?policy",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteBucketPolicyInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteBucketPolicyOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketPolicy API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes the policy from the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteBucketPolicy for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketPolicy
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketPolicy(input *DeleteBucketPolicyInput) (*DeleteBucketPolicyOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketPolicyRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketPolicyWithContext is the same as DeleteBucketPolicy with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketPolicy for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteBucketPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteBucketPolicyOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketPolicyRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteBucketReplication = "DeleteBucketReplication"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketReplicationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteBucketReplication operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketReplication for more information on using the DeleteBucketReplication
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteBucketReplicationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteBucketReplicationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketReplication
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketReplicationRequest(input *DeleteBucketReplicationInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteBucketReplicationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteBucketReplication,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?replication",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteBucketReplicationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteBucketReplicationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketReplication API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes the replication configuration from the bucket. For information about
|
|
// replication configuration, see Cross-Region Replication (CRR) ( https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/crr.html)
|
|
// in the Amazon S3 Developer Guide.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteBucketReplication for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketReplication
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketReplication(input *DeleteBucketReplicationInput) (*DeleteBucketReplicationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketReplicationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketReplicationWithContext is the same as DeleteBucketReplication with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketReplication for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketReplicationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteBucketReplicationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteBucketReplicationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketReplicationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteBucketTagging = "DeleteBucketTagging"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketTaggingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteBucketTagging operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketTagging for more information on using the DeleteBucketTagging
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteBucketTaggingRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteBucketTaggingRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketTagging
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketTaggingRequest(input *DeleteBucketTaggingInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteBucketTaggingOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteBucketTagging,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?tagging",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteBucketTaggingInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteBucketTaggingOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketTagging API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes the tags from the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteBucketTagging for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketTagging
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketTagging(input *DeleteBucketTaggingInput) (*DeleteBucketTaggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketTaggingRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketTaggingWithContext is the same as DeleteBucketTagging with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketTagging for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketTaggingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteBucketTaggingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteBucketTaggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketTaggingRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteBucketWebsite = "DeleteBucketWebsite"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketWebsiteRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteBucketWebsite operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketWebsite for more information on using the DeleteBucketWebsite
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteBucketWebsiteRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteBucketWebsiteRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketWebsite
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketWebsiteRequest(input *DeleteBucketWebsiteInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteBucketWebsiteOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteBucketWebsite,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?website",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteBucketWebsiteInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteBucketWebsiteOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketWebsite API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// This operation removes the website configuration from the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteBucketWebsite for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteBucketWebsite
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketWebsite(input *DeleteBucketWebsiteInput) (*DeleteBucketWebsiteOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketWebsiteRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteBucketWebsiteWithContext is the same as DeleteBucketWebsite with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteBucketWebsite for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteBucketWebsiteWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteBucketWebsiteInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteBucketWebsiteOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteBucketWebsiteRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteObject = "DeleteObject"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteObjectRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteObject operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteObject for more information on using the DeleteObject
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteObjectRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteObjectRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteObject
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteObjectRequest(input *DeleteObjectInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteObjectOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteObject,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteObjectInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteObjectOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteObject API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Removes the null version (if there is one) of an object and inserts a delete
|
|
// marker, which becomes the latest version of the object. If there isn't a
|
|
// null version, Amazon S3 does not remove any objects.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteObject for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteObject
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteObject(input *DeleteObjectInput) (*DeleteObjectOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteObjectRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteObjectWithContext is the same as DeleteObject with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteObject for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteObjectWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteObjectInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteObjectOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteObjectRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteObjectTagging = "DeleteObjectTagging"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteObjectTaggingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteObjectTagging operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteObjectTagging for more information on using the DeleteObjectTagging
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteObjectTaggingRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteObjectTaggingRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteObjectTagging
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteObjectTaggingRequest(input *DeleteObjectTaggingInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteObjectTaggingOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteObjectTagging,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}?tagging",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteObjectTaggingInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteObjectTaggingOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteObjectTagging API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Removes the tag-set from an existing object.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteObjectTagging for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteObjectTagging
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteObjectTagging(input *DeleteObjectTaggingInput) (*DeleteObjectTaggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteObjectTaggingRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteObjectTaggingWithContext is the same as DeleteObjectTagging with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteObjectTagging for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteObjectTaggingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteObjectTaggingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteObjectTaggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteObjectTaggingRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteObjects = "DeleteObjects"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteObjectsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteObjects operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteObjects for more information on using the DeleteObjects
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteObjectsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteObjectsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteObjects
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteObjectsRequest(input *DeleteObjectsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteObjectsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteObjects,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?delete",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteObjectsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteObjectsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteObjects API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// This operation enables you to delete multiple objects from a bucket using
|
|
// a single HTTP request. You may specify up to 1000 keys.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeleteObjects for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeleteObjects
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteObjects(input *DeleteObjectsInput) (*DeleteObjectsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteObjectsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteObjectsWithContext is the same as DeleteObjects with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteObjects for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeleteObjectsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteObjectsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteObjectsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteObjectsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeletePublicAccessBlock = "DeletePublicAccessBlock"
|
|
|
|
// DeletePublicAccessBlockRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeletePublicAccessBlock operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeletePublicAccessBlock for more information on using the DeletePublicAccessBlock
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeletePublicAccessBlockRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeletePublicAccessBlockRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeletePublicAccessBlock
|
|
func (c *S3) DeletePublicAccessBlockRequest(input *DeletePublicAccessBlockInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeletePublicAccessBlockOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeletePublicAccessBlock,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?publicAccessBlock",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeletePublicAccessBlockInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeletePublicAccessBlockOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeletePublicAccessBlock API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Removes the PublicAccessBlock configuration from an Amazon S3 bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation DeletePublicAccessBlock for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/DeletePublicAccessBlock
|
|
func (c *S3) DeletePublicAccessBlock(input *DeletePublicAccessBlockInput) (*DeletePublicAccessBlockOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeletePublicAccessBlockRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeletePublicAccessBlockWithContext is the same as DeletePublicAccessBlock with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeletePublicAccessBlock for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) DeletePublicAccessBlockWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeletePublicAccessBlockInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeletePublicAccessBlockOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeletePublicAccessBlockRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketAccelerateConfiguration = "GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration for more information on using the GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest(input *GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketAccelerateConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?accelerate",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the accelerate configuration of a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration(input *GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) (*GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationWithContext is the same as GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketAcl = "GetBucketAcl"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketAclRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketAcl operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketAcl for more information on using the GetBucketAcl
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketAclRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketAclRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketAcl
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketAclRequest(input *GetBucketAclInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketAclOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketAcl,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?acl",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketAclInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketAclOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketAcl API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Gets the access control policy for the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketAcl for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketAcl
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketAcl(input *GetBucketAclInput) (*GetBucketAclOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketAclRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketAclWithContext is the same as GetBucketAcl with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketAcl for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketAclWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketAclInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketAclOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketAclRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration = "GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration for more information on using the GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest(input *GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?analytics",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Gets an analytics configuration for the bucket (specified by the analytics
|
|
// configuration ID).
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration(input *GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) (*GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationWithContext is the same as GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketCors = "GetBucketCors"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketCorsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketCors operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketCors for more information on using the GetBucketCors
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketCorsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketCorsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketCors
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketCorsRequest(input *GetBucketCorsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketCorsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketCors,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?cors",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketCorsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketCorsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketCors API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the CORS configuration for the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketCors for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketCors
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketCors(input *GetBucketCorsInput) (*GetBucketCorsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketCorsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketCorsWithContext is the same as GetBucketCors with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketCors for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketCorsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketCorsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketCorsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketCorsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketEncryption = "GetBucketEncryption"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketEncryptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketEncryption operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketEncryption for more information on using the GetBucketEncryption
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketEncryptionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketEncryptionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketEncryption
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketEncryptionRequest(input *GetBucketEncryptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketEncryptionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketEncryption,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?encryption",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketEncryptionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketEncryptionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketEncryption API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the server-side encryption configuration of a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketEncryption for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketEncryption
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketEncryption(input *GetBucketEncryptionInput) (*GetBucketEncryptionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketEncryptionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketEncryptionWithContext is the same as GetBucketEncryption with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketEncryption for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketEncryptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketEncryptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketEncryptionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketEncryptionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketInventoryConfiguration = "GetBucketInventoryConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketInventoryConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketInventoryConfiguration for more information on using the GetBucketInventoryConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketInventoryConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest(input *GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketInventoryConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?inventory",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketInventoryConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns an inventory configuration (identified by the inventory ID) from
|
|
// the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketInventoryConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketInventoryConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketInventoryConfiguration(input *GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) (*GetBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketInventoryConfigurationWithContext is the same as GetBucketInventoryConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketInventoryConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketInventoryConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketLifecycle = "GetBucketLifecycle"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketLifecycleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketLifecycle operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketLifecycle for more information on using the GetBucketLifecycle
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketLifecycleRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketLifecycleRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketLifecycle
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: GetBucketLifecycle has been deprecated
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketLifecycleRequest(input *GetBucketLifecycleInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketLifecycleOutput) {
|
|
if c.Client.Config.Logger != nil {
|
|
c.Client.Config.Logger.Log("This operation, GetBucketLifecycle, has been deprecated")
|
|
}
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketLifecycle,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?lifecycle",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketLifecycleInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketLifecycleOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketLifecycle API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// No longer used, see the GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketLifecycle for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketLifecycle
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: GetBucketLifecycle has been deprecated
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketLifecycle(input *GetBucketLifecycleInput) (*GetBucketLifecycleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketLifecycleRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketLifecycleWithContext is the same as GetBucketLifecycle with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketLifecycle for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: GetBucketLifecycleWithContext has been deprecated
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketLifecycleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketLifecycleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketLifecycleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketLifecycleRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketLifecycleConfiguration = "GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration for more information on using the GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest(input *GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketLifecycleConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?lifecycle",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the lifecycle configuration information set on the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration(input *GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) (*GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationWithContext is the same as GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketLocation = "GetBucketLocation"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketLocationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketLocation operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketLocation for more information on using the GetBucketLocation
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketLocationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketLocationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketLocation
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketLocationRequest(input *GetBucketLocationInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketLocationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketLocation,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?location",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketLocationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketLocationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketLocation API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the region the bucket resides in.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketLocation for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketLocation
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketLocation(input *GetBucketLocationInput) (*GetBucketLocationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketLocationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketLocationWithContext is the same as GetBucketLocation with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketLocation for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketLocationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketLocationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketLocationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketLocationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketLogging = "GetBucketLogging"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketLoggingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketLogging operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketLogging for more information on using the GetBucketLogging
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketLoggingRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketLoggingRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketLogging
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketLoggingRequest(input *GetBucketLoggingInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketLoggingOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketLogging,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?logging",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketLoggingInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketLoggingOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketLogging API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the logging status of a bucket and the permissions users have to
|
|
// view and modify that status. To use GET, you must be the bucket owner.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketLogging for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketLogging
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketLogging(input *GetBucketLoggingInput) (*GetBucketLoggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketLoggingRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketLoggingWithContext is the same as GetBucketLogging with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketLogging for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketLoggingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketLoggingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketLoggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketLoggingRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketMetricsConfiguration = "GetBucketMetricsConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketMetricsConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketMetricsConfiguration for more information on using the GetBucketMetricsConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketMetricsConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest(input *GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketMetricsConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?metrics",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketMetricsConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Gets a metrics configuration (specified by the metrics configuration ID)
|
|
// from the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketMetricsConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketMetricsConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketMetricsConfiguration(input *GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) (*GetBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketMetricsConfigurationWithContext is the same as GetBucketMetricsConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketMetricsConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketMetricsConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketNotification = "GetBucketNotification"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketNotificationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketNotification operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketNotification for more information on using the GetBucketNotification
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketNotificationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketNotificationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketNotification
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: GetBucketNotification has been deprecated
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketNotificationRequest(input *GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest) (req *request.Request, output *NotificationConfigurationDeprecated) {
|
|
if c.Client.Config.Logger != nil {
|
|
c.Client.Config.Logger.Log("This operation, GetBucketNotification, has been deprecated")
|
|
}
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketNotification,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?notification",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &NotificationConfigurationDeprecated{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketNotification API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// No longer used, see the GetBucketNotificationConfiguration operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketNotification for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketNotification
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: GetBucketNotification has been deprecated
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketNotification(input *GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest) (*NotificationConfigurationDeprecated, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketNotificationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketNotificationWithContext is the same as GetBucketNotification with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketNotification for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: GetBucketNotificationWithContext has been deprecated
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketNotificationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest, opts ...request.Option) (*NotificationConfigurationDeprecated, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketNotificationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketNotificationConfiguration = "GetBucketNotificationConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketNotificationConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketNotificationConfiguration for more information on using the GetBucketNotificationConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketNotificationConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest(input *GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest) (req *request.Request, output *NotificationConfiguration) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketNotificationConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?notification",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &NotificationConfiguration{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketNotificationConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the notification configuration of a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketNotificationConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketNotificationConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketNotificationConfiguration(input *GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest) (*NotificationConfiguration, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketNotificationConfigurationWithContext is the same as GetBucketNotificationConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketNotificationConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketNotificationConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest, opts ...request.Option) (*NotificationConfiguration, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketPolicy = "GetBucketPolicy"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketPolicy operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketPolicy for more information on using the GetBucketPolicy
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketPolicyRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketPolicyRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketPolicy
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketPolicyRequest(input *GetBucketPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketPolicyOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketPolicy,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?policy",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketPolicyInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketPolicyOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketPolicy API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the policy of a specified bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketPolicy for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketPolicy
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketPolicy(input *GetBucketPolicyInput) (*GetBucketPolicyOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketPolicyRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketPolicyWithContext is the same as GetBucketPolicy with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketPolicy for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketPolicyOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketPolicyRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketPolicyStatus = "GetBucketPolicyStatus"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketPolicyStatusRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketPolicyStatus operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketPolicyStatus for more information on using the GetBucketPolicyStatus
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketPolicyStatusRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketPolicyStatusRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketPolicyStatus
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketPolicyStatusRequest(input *GetBucketPolicyStatusInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketPolicyStatusOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketPolicyStatus,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?policyStatus",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketPolicyStatusInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketPolicyStatusOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketPolicyStatus API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves the policy status for an Amazon S3 bucket, indicating whether the
|
|
// bucket is public.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketPolicyStatus for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketPolicyStatus
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketPolicyStatus(input *GetBucketPolicyStatusInput) (*GetBucketPolicyStatusOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketPolicyStatusRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketPolicyStatusWithContext is the same as GetBucketPolicyStatus with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketPolicyStatus for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketPolicyStatusWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketPolicyStatusInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketPolicyStatusOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketPolicyStatusRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketReplication = "GetBucketReplication"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketReplicationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketReplication operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketReplication for more information on using the GetBucketReplication
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketReplicationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketReplicationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketReplication
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketReplicationRequest(input *GetBucketReplicationInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketReplicationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketReplication,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?replication",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketReplicationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketReplicationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketReplication API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the replication configuration of a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// It can take a while to propagate the put or delete a replication configuration
|
|
// to all Amazon S3 systems. Therefore, a get request soon after put or delete
|
|
// can return a wrong result.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketReplication for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketReplication
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketReplication(input *GetBucketReplicationInput) (*GetBucketReplicationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketReplicationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketReplicationWithContext is the same as GetBucketReplication with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketReplication for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketReplicationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketReplicationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketReplicationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketReplicationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketRequestPayment = "GetBucketRequestPayment"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketRequestPaymentRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketRequestPayment operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketRequestPayment for more information on using the GetBucketRequestPayment
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketRequestPaymentRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketRequestPaymentRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketRequestPayment
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketRequestPaymentRequest(input *GetBucketRequestPaymentInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketRequestPaymentOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketRequestPayment,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?requestPayment",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketRequestPaymentInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketRequestPaymentOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketRequestPayment API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the request payment configuration of a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketRequestPayment for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketRequestPayment
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketRequestPayment(input *GetBucketRequestPaymentInput) (*GetBucketRequestPaymentOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketRequestPaymentRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketRequestPaymentWithContext is the same as GetBucketRequestPayment with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketRequestPayment for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketRequestPaymentWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketRequestPaymentInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketRequestPaymentOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketRequestPaymentRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketTagging = "GetBucketTagging"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketTaggingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketTagging operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketTagging for more information on using the GetBucketTagging
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketTaggingRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketTaggingRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketTagging
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketTaggingRequest(input *GetBucketTaggingInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketTaggingOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketTagging,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?tagging",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketTaggingInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketTaggingOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketTagging API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the tag set associated with the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketTagging for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketTagging
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketTagging(input *GetBucketTaggingInput) (*GetBucketTaggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketTaggingRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketTaggingWithContext is the same as GetBucketTagging with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketTagging for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketTaggingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketTaggingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketTaggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketTaggingRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketVersioning = "GetBucketVersioning"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketVersioningRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketVersioning operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketVersioning for more information on using the GetBucketVersioning
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketVersioningRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketVersioningRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketVersioning
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketVersioningRequest(input *GetBucketVersioningInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketVersioningOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketVersioning,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?versioning",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketVersioningInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketVersioningOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketVersioning API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the versioning state of a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketVersioning for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketVersioning
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketVersioning(input *GetBucketVersioningInput) (*GetBucketVersioningOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketVersioningRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketVersioningWithContext is the same as GetBucketVersioning with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketVersioning for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketVersioningWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketVersioningInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketVersioningOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketVersioningRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetBucketWebsite = "GetBucketWebsite"
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketWebsiteRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetBucketWebsite operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketWebsite for more information on using the GetBucketWebsite
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetBucketWebsiteRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetBucketWebsiteRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketWebsite
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketWebsiteRequest(input *GetBucketWebsiteInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetBucketWebsiteOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetBucketWebsite,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?website",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetBucketWebsiteInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetBucketWebsiteOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketWebsite API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the website configuration for a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetBucketWebsite for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetBucketWebsite
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketWebsite(input *GetBucketWebsiteInput) (*GetBucketWebsiteOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketWebsiteRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetBucketWebsiteWithContext is the same as GetBucketWebsite with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetBucketWebsite for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetBucketWebsiteWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetBucketWebsiteInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetBucketWebsiteOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetBucketWebsiteRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetObject = "GetObject"
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetObject operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObject for more information on using the GetObject
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetObjectRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetObjectRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObject
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectRequest(input *GetObjectInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetObjectOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetObject,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetObjectInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetObjectOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObject API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves objects from Amazon S3.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetObject for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeNoSuchKey "NoSuchKey"
|
|
// The specified key does not exist.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObject
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObject(input *GetObjectInput) (*GetObjectOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectWithContext is the same as GetObject with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObject for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetObjectInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetObjectOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetObjectAcl = "GetObjectAcl"
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectAclRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetObjectAcl operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObjectAcl for more information on using the GetObjectAcl
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetObjectAclRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetObjectAclRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObjectAcl
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectAclRequest(input *GetObjectAclInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetObjectAclOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetObjectAcl,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}?acl",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetObjectAclInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetObjectAclOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectAcl API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the access control list (ACL) of an object.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetObjectAcl for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeNoSuchKey "NoSuchKey"
|
|
// The specified key does not exist.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObjectAcl
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectAcl(input *GetObjectAclInput) (*GetObjectAclOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectAclRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectAclWithContext is the same as GetObjectAcl with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObjectAcl for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectAclWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetObjectAclInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetObjectAclOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectAclRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetObjectLegalHold = "GetObjectLegalHold"
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectLegalHoldRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetObjectLegalHold operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObjectLegalHold for more information on using the GetObjectLegalHold
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetObjectLegalHoldRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetObjectLegalHoldRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObjectLegalHold
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectLegalHoldRequest(input *GetObjectLegalHoldInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetObjectLegalHoldOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetObjectLegalHold,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}?legal-hold",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetObjectLegalHoldInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetObjectLegalHoldOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectLegalHold API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Gets an object's current Legal Hold status.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetObjectLegalHold for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObjectLegalHold
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectLegalHold(input *GetObjectLegalHoldInput) (*GetObjectLegalHoldOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectLegalHoldRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectLegalHoldWithContext is the same as GetObjectLegalHold with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObjectLegalHold for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectLegalHoldWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetObjectLegalHoldInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetObjectLegalHoldOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectLegalHoldRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetObjectLockConfiguration = "GetObjectLockConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectLockConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetObjectLockConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObjectLockConfiguration for more information on using the GetObjectLockConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetObjectLockConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetObjectLockConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObjectLockConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectLockConfigurationRequest(input *GetObjectLockConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetObjectLockConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetObjectLockConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?object-lock",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetObjectLockConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetObjectLockConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectLockConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Gets the Object Lock configuration for a bucket. The rule specified in the
|
|
// Object Lock configuration will be applied by default to every new object
|
|
// placed in the specified bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetObjectLockConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObjectLockConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectLockConfiguration(input *GetObjectLockConfigurationInput) (*GetObjectLockConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectLockConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectLockConfigurationWithContext is the same as GetObjectLockConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObjectLockConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectLockConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetObjectLockConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetObjectLockConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectLockConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetObjectRetention = "GetObjectRetention"
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectRetentionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetObjectRetention operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObjectRetention for more information on using the GetObjectRetention
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetObjectRetentionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetObjectRetentionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObjectRetention
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectRetentionRequest(input *GetObjectRetentionInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetObjectRetentionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetObjectRetention,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}?retention",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetObjectRetentionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetObjectRetentionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectRetention API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves an object's retention settings.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetObjectRetention for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObjectRetention
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectRetention(input *GetObjectRetentionInput) (*GetObjectRetentionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectRetentionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectRetentionWithContext is the same as GetObjectRetention with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObjectRetention for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectRetentionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetObjectRetentionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetObjectRetentionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectRetentionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetObjectTagging = "GetObjectTagging"
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectTaggingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetObjectTagging operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObjectTagging for more information on using the GetObjectTagging
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetObjectTaggingRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetObjectTaggingRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObjectTagging
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectTaggingRequest(input *GetObjectTaggingInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetObjectTaggingOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetObjectTagging,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}?tagging",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetObjectTaggingInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetObjectTaggingOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectTagging API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns the tag-set of an object.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetObjectTagging for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObjectTagging
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectTagging(input *GetObjectTaggingInput) (*GetObjectTaggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectTaggingRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectTaggingWithContext is the same as GetObjectTagging with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObjectTagging for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectTaggingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetObjectTaggingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetObjectTaggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectTaggingRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetObjectTorrent = "GetObjectTorrent"
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectTorrentRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetObjectTorrent operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObjectTorrent for more information on using the GetObjectTorrent
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetObjectTorrentRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetObjectTorrentRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObjectTorrent
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectTorrentRequest(input *GetObjectTorrentInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetObjectTorrentOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetObjectTorrent,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}?torrent",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetObjectTorrentInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetObjectTorrentOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectTorrent API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Return torrent files from a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetObjectTorrent for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetObjectTorrent
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectTorrent(input *GetObjectTorrentInput) (*GetObjectTorrentOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectTorrentRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetObjectTorrentWithContext is the same as GetObjectTorrent with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetObjectTorrent for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetObjectTorrentWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetObjectTorrentInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetObjectTorrentOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetObjectTorrentRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opGetPublicAccessBlock = "GetPublicAccessBlock"
|
|
|
|
// GetPublicAccessBlockRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the GetPublicAccessBlock operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetPublicAccessBlock for more information on using the GetPublicAccessBlock
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the GetPublicAccessBlockRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.GetPublicAccessBlockRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetPublicAccessBlock
|
|
func (c *S3) GetPublicAccessBlockRequest(input *GetPublicAccessBlockInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetPublicAccessBlockOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opGetPublicAccessBlock,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?publicAccessBlock",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &GetPublicAccessBlockInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &GetPublicAccessBlockOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetPublicAccessBlock API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Retrieves the PublicAccessBlock configuration for an Amazon S3 bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation GetPublicAccessBlock for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/GetPublicAccessBlock
|
|
func (c *S3) GetPublicAccessBlock(input *GetPublicAccessBlockInput) (*GetPublicAccessBlockOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetPublicAccessBlockRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GetPublicAccessBlockWithContext is the same as GetPublicAccessBlock with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See GetPublicAccessBlock for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) GetPublicAccessBlockWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetPublicAccessBlockInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetPublicAccessBlockOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.GetPublicAccessBlockRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opHeadBucket = "HeadBucket"
|
|
|
|
// HeadBucketRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the HeadBucket operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See HeadBucket for more information on using the HeadBucket
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the HeadBucketRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.HeadBucketRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/HeadBucket
|
|
func (c *S3) HeadBucketRequest(input *HeadBucketInput) (req *request.Request, output *HeadBucketOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opHeadBucket,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "HEAD",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &HeadBucketInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &HeadBucketOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// HeadBucket API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// This operation is useful to determine if a bucket exists and you have permission
|
|
// to access it.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation HeadBucket for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeNoSuchBucket "NoSuchBucket"
|
|
// The specified bucket does not exist.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/HeadBucket
|
|
func (c *S3) HeadBucket(input *HeadBucketInput) (*HeadBucketOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.HeadBucketRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// HeadBucketWithContext is the same as HeadBucket with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See HeadBucket for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) HeadBucketWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *HeadBucketInput, opts ...request.Option) (*HeadBucketOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.HeadBucketRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opHeadObject = "HeadObject"
|
|
|
|
// HeadObjectRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the HeadObject operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See HeadObject for more information on using the HeadObject
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the HeadObjectRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.HeadObjectRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/HeadObject
|
|
func (c *S3) HeadObjectRequest(input *HeadObjectInput) (req *request.Request, output *HeadObjectOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opHeadObject,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "HEAD",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &HeadObjectInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &HeadObjectOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// HeadObject API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// The HEAD operation retrieves metadata from an object without returning the
|
|
// object itself. This operation is useful if you're only interested in an object's
|
|
// metadata. To use HEAD, you must have READ access to the object.
|
|
//
|
|
// See http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/ErrorResponses.html#RESTErrorResponses
|
|
// for more information on returned errors.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation HeadObject for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/HeadObject
|
|
func (c *S3) HeadObject(input *HeadObjectInput) (*HeadObjectOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.HeadObjectRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// HeadObjectWithContext is the same as HeadObject with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See HeadObject for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) HeadObjectWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *HeadObjectInput, opts ...request.Option) (*HeadObjectOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.HeadObjectRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations = "ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations"
|
|
|
|
// ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations for more information on using the ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations
|
|
func (c *S3) ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsRequest(input *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?analytics",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Lists the analytics configurations for the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations
|
|
func (c *S3) ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations(input *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput) (*ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsWithContext is the same as ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListBucketInventoryConfigurations = "ListBucketInventoryConfigurations"
|
|
|
|
// ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListBucketInventoryConfigurations operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListBucketInventoryConfigurations for more information on using the ListBucketInventoryConfigurations
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListBucketInventoryConfigurations
|
|
func (c *S3) ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsRequest(input *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListBucketInventoryConfigurations,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?inventory",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListBucketInventoryConfigurations API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns a list of inventory configurations for the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation ListBucketInventoryConfigurations for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListBucketInventoryConfigurations
|
|
func (c *S3) ListBucketInventoryConfigurations(input *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput) (*ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsWithContext is the same as ListBucketInventoryConfigurations with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListBucketInventoryConfigurations for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListBucketMetricsConfigurations = "ListBucketMetricsConfigurations"
|
|
|
|
// ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListBucketMetricsConfigurations operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListBucketMetricsConfigurations for more information on using the ListBucketMetricsConfigurations
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListBucketMetricsConfigurations
|
|
func (c *S3) ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsRequest(input *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListBucketMetricsConfigurations,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?metrics",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListBucketMetricsConfigurations API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Lists the metrics configurations for the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation ListBucketMetricsConfigurations for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListBucketMetricsConfigurations
|
|
func (c *S3) ListBucketMetricsConfigurations(input *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput) (*ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsWithContext is the same as ListBucketMetricsConfigurations with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListBucketMetricsConfigurations for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListBuckets = "ListBuckets"
|
|
|
|
// ListBucketsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListBuckets operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListBuckets for more information on using the ListBuckets
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListBucketsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListBucketsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListBuckets
|
|
func (c *S3) ListBucketsRequest(input *ListBucketsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListBucketsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListBuckets,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListBucketsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListBucketsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListBuckets API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns a list of all buckets owned by the authenticated sender of the request.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation ListBuckets for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListBuckets
|
|
func (c *S3) ListBuckets(input *ListBucketsInput) (*ListBucketsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListBucketsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListBucketsWithContext is the same as ListBuckets with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListBuckets for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListBucketsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListBucketsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListBucketsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListBucketsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListMultipartUploads = "ListMultipartUploads"
|
|
|
|
// ListMultipartUploadsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListMultipartUploads operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListMultipartUploads for more information on using the ListMultipartUploads
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListMultipartUploadsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListMultipartUploadsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListMultipartUploads
|
|
func (c *S3) ListMultipartUploadsRequest(input *ListMultipartUploadsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListMultipartUploads,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?uploads",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"KeyMarker", "UploadIdMarker"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextKeyMarker", "NextUploadIdMarker"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxUploads",
|
|
TruncationToken: "IsTruncated",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListMultipartUploadsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListMultipartUploadsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListMultipartUploads API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// This operation lists in-progress multipart uploads.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation ListMultipartUploads for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListMultipartUploads
|
|
func (c *S3) ListMultipartUploads(input *ListMultipartUploadsInput) (*ListMultipartUploadsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListMultipartUploadsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListMultipartUploadsWithContext is the same as ListMultipartUploads with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListMultipartUploads for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListMultipartUploadsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListMultipartUploadsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListMultipartUploadsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListMultipartUploadsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListMultipartUploadsPages iterates over the pages of a ListMultipartUploads operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListMultipartUploads method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListMultipartUploads operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.ListMultipartUploadsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *ListMultipartUploadsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *S3) ListMultipartUploadsPages(input *ListMultipartUploadsInput, fn func(*ListMultipartUploadsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.ListMultipartUploadsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListMultipartUploadsPagesWithContext same as ListMultipartUploadsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListMultipartUploadsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListMultipartUploadsInput, fn func(*ListMultipartUploadsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *ListMultipartUploadsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.ListMultipartUploadsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListMultipartUploadsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListObjectVersions = "ListObjectVersions"
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectVersionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListObjectVersions operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListObjectVersions for more information on using the ListObjectVersions
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListObjectVersionsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListObjectVersionsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListObjectVersions
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectVersionsRequest(input *ListObjectVersionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListObjectVersionsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListObjectVersions,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?versions",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"KeyMarker", "VersionIdMarker"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextKeyMarker", "NextVersionIdMarker"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxKeys",
|
|
TruncationToken: "IsTruncated",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListObjectVersionsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListObjectVersionsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectVersions API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns metadata about all of the versions of objects in a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation ListObjectVersions for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListObjectVersions
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectVersions(input *ListObjectVersionsInput) (*ListObjectVersionsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListObjectVersionsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectVersionsWithContext is the same as ListObjectVersions with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListObjectVersions for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectVersionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListObjectVersionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListObjectVersionsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListObjectVersionsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectVersionsPages iterates over the pages of a ListObjectVersions operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListObjectVersions method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListObjectVersions operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.ListObjectVersionsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *ListObjectVersionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectVersionsPages(input *ListObjectVersionsInput, fn func(*ListObjectVersionsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.ListObjectVersionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectVersionsPagesWithContext same as ListObjectVersionsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectVersionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListObjectVersionsInput, fn func(*ListObjectVersionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *ListObjectVersionsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.ListObjectVersionsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListObjectVersionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListObjects = "ListObjects"
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListObjects operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListObjects for more information on using the ListObjects
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListObjectsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListObjectsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListObjects
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectsRequest(input *ListObjectsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListObjectsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListObjects,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"Marker"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextMarker || Contents[-1].Key"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxKeys",
|
|
TruncationToken: "IsTruncated",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListObjectsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListObjectsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListObjects API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns some or all (up to 1000) of the objects in a bucket. You can use
|
|
// the request parameters as selection criteria to return a subset of the objects
|
|
// in a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation ListObjects for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeNoSuchBucket "NoSuchBucket"
|
|
// The specified bucket does not exist.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListObjects
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjects(input *ListObjectsInput) (*ListObjectsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListObjectsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectsWithContext is the same as ListObjects with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListObjects for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListObjectsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListObjectsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListObjectsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectsPages iterates over the pages of a ListObjects operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListObjects method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListObjects operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.ListObjectsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *ListObjectsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectsPages(input *ListObjectsInput, fn func(*ListObjectsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.ListObjectsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectsPagesWithContext same as ListObjectsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListObjectsInput, fn func(*ListObjectsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *ListObjectsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.ListObjectsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListObjectsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListObjectsV2 = "ListObjectsV2"
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectsV2Request generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListObjectsV2 operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListObjectsV2 for more information on using the ListObjectsV2
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListObjectsV2Request method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListObjectsV2Request(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListObjectsV2
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectsV2Request(input *ListObjectsV2Input) (req *request.Request, output *ListObjectsV2Output) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListObjectsV2,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?list-type=2",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"ContinuationToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextContinuationToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxKeys",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListObjectsV2Input{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListObjectsV2Output{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectsV2 API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns some or all (up to 1000) of the objects in a bucket. You can use
|
|
// the request parameters as selection criteria to return a subset of the objects
|
|
// in a bucket. Note: ListObjectsV2 is the revised List Objects API and we recommend
|
|
// you use this revised API for new application development.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation ListObjectsV2 for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeNoSuchBucket "NoSuchBucket"
|
|
// The specified bucket does not exist.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListObjectsV2
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectsV2(input *ListObjectsV2Input) (*ListObjectsV2Output, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListObjectsV2Request(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectsV2WithContext is the same as ListObjectsV2 with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListObjectsV2 for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectsV2WithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListObjectsV2Input, opts ...request.Option) (*ListObjectsV2Output, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListObjectsV2Request(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectsV2Pages iterates over the pages of a ListObjectsV2 operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListObjectsV2 method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListObjectsV2 operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.ListObjectsV2Pages(params,
|
|
// func(page *ListObjectsV2Output, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectsV2Pages(input *ListObjectsV2Input, fn func(*ListObjectsV2Output, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.ListObjectsV2PagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListObjectsV2PagesWithContext same as ListObjectsV2Pages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListObjectsV2PagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListObjectsV2Input, fn func(*ListObjectsV2Output, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *ListObjectsV2Input
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.ListObjectsV2Request(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListObjectsV2Output), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListParts = "ListParts"
|
|
|
|
// ListPartsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListParts operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListParts for more information on using the ListParts
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListPartsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListPartsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListParts
|
|
func (c *S3) ListPartsRequest(input *ListPartsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListPartsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListParts,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"PartNumberMarker"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextPartNumberMarker"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxParts",
|
|
TruncationToken: "IsTruncated",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListPartsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListPartsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListParts API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Lists the parts that have been uploaded for a specific multipart upload.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation ListParts for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/ListParts
|
|
func (c *S3) ListParts(input *ListPartsInput) (*ListPartsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListPartsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListPartsWithContext is the same as ListParts with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListParts for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListPartsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListPartsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListPartsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListPartsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListPartsPages iterates over the pages of a ListParts operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListParts method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListParts operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.ListPartsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *ListPartsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *S3) ListPartsPages(input *ListPartsInput, fn func(*ListPartsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.ListPartsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListPartsPagesWithContext same as ListPartsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) ListPartsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListPartsInput, fn func(*ListPartsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *ListPartsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.ListPartsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListPartsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketAccelerateConfiguration = "PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration for more information on using the PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest(input *PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketAccelerateConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?accelerate",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Sets the accelerate configuration of an existing bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration(input *PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) (*PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationWithContext is the same as PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketAcl = "PutBucketAcl"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketAclRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketAcl operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketAcl for more information on using the PutBucketAcl
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketAclRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketAclRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketAcl
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketAclRequest(input *PutBucketAclInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketAclOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketAcl,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?acl",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketAclInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketAclOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketAcl API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Sets the permissions on a bucket using access control lists (ACL).
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketAcl for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketAcl
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketAcl(input *PutBucketAclInput) (*PutBucketAclOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketAclRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketAclWithContext is the same as PutBucketAcl with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketAcl for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketAclWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketAclInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketAclOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketAclRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration = "PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration for more information on using the PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest(input *PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?analytics",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Sets an analytics configuration for the bucket (specified by the analytics
|
|
// configuration ID).
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration(input *PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) (*PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationWithContext is the same as PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketCors = "PutBucketCors"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketCorsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketCors operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketCors for more information on using the PutBucketCors
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketCorsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketCorsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketCors
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketCorsRequest(input *PutBucketCorsInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketCorsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketCors,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?cors",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketCorsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketCorsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketCors API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Sets the CORS configuration for a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketCors for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketCors
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketCors(input *PutBucketCorsInput) (*PutBucketCorsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketCorsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketCorsWithContext is the same as PutBucketCors with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketCors for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketCorsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketCorsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketCorsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketCorsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketEncryption = "PutBucketEncryption"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketEncryptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketEncryption operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketEncryption for more information on using the PutBucketEncryption
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketEncryptionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketEncryptionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketEncryption
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketEncryptionRequest(input *PutBucketEncryptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketEncryptionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketEncryption,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?encryption",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketEncryptionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketEncryptionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketEncryption API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a new server-side encryption configuration (or replaces an existing
|
|
// one, if present).
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketEncryption for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketEncryption
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketEncryption(input *PutBucketEncryptionInput) (*PutBucketEncryptionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketEncryptionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketEncryptionWithContext is the same as PutBucketEncryption with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketEncryption for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketEncryptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketEncryptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketEncryptionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketEncryptionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketInventoryConfiguration = "PutBucketInventoryConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketInventoryConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketInventoryConfiguration for more information on using the PutBucketInventoryConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketInventoryConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest(input *PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketInventoryConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?inventory",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketInventoryConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Adds an inventory configuration (identified by the inventory ID) from the
|
|
// bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketInventoryConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketInventoryConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketInventoryConfiguration(input *PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) (*PutBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketInventoryConfigurationWithContext is the same as PutBucketInventoryConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketInventoryConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketInventoryConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketLifecycle = "PutBucketLifecycle"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketLifecycleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketLifecycle operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketLifecycle for more information on using the PutBucketLifecycle
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketLifecycleRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketLifecycleRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketLifecycle
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: PutBucketLifecycle has been deprecated
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketLifecycleRequest(input *PutBucketLifecycleInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketLifecycleOutput) {
|
|
if c.Client.Config.Logger != nil {
|
|
c.Client.Config.Logger.Log("This operation, PutBucketLifecycle, has been deprecated")
|
|
}
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketLifecycle,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?lifecycle",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketLifecycleInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketLifecycleOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketLifecycle API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// No longer used, see the PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketLifecycle for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketLifecycle
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: PutBucketLifecycle has been deprecated
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketLifecycle(input *PutBucketLifecycleInput) (*PutBucketLifecycleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketLifecycleRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketLifecycleWithContext is the same as PutBucketLifecycle with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketLifecycle for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: PutBucketLifecycleWithContext has been deprecated
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketLifecycleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketLifecycleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketLifecycleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketLifecycleRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketLifecycleConfiguration = "PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration for more information on using the PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest(input *PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketLifecycleConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?lifecycle",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Sets lifecycle configuration for your bucket. If a lifecycle configuration
|
|
// exists, it replaces it.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration(input *PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) (*PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationWithContext is the same as PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketLogging = "PutBucketLogging"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketLoggingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketLogging operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketLogging for more information on using the PutBucketLogging
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketLoggingRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketLoggingRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketLogging
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketLoggingRequest(input *PutBucketLoggingInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketLoggingOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketLogging,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?logging",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketLoggingInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketLoggingOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketLogging API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Set the logging parameters for a bucket and to specify permissions for who
|
|
// can view and modify the logging parameters. To set the logging status of
|
|
// a bucket, you must be the bucket owner.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketLogging for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketLogging
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketLogging(input *PutBucketLoggingInput) (*PutBucketLoggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketLoggingRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketLoggingWithContext is the same as PutBucketLogging with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketLogging for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketLoggingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketLoggingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketLoggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketLoggingRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketMetricsConfiguration = "PutBucketMetricsConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketMetricsConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketMetricsConfiguration for more information on using the PutBucketMetricsConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketMetricsConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest(input *PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketMetricsConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?metrics",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketMetricsConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Sets a metrics configuration (specified by the metrics configuration ID)
|
|
// for the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketMetricsConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketMetricsConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketMetricsConfiguration(input *PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) (*PutBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketMetricsConfigurationWithContext is the same as PutBucketMetricsConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketMetricsConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketMetricsConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketNotification = "PutBucketNotification"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketNotificationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketNotification operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketNotification for more information on using the PutBucketNotification
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketNotificationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketNotificationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketNotification
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: PutBucketNotification has been deprecated
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketNotificationRequest(input *PutBucketNotificationInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketNotificationOutput) {
|
|
if c.Client.Config.Logger != nil {
|
|
c.Client.Config.Logger.Log("This operation, PutBucketNotification, has been deprecated")
|
|
}
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketNotification,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?notification",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketNotificationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketNotificationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketNotification API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// No longer used, see the PutBucketNotificationConfiguration operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketNotification for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketNotification
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: PutBucketNotification has been deprecated
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketNotification(input *PutBucketNotificationInput) (*PutBucketNotificationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketNotificationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketNotificationWithContext is the same as PutBucketNotification with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketNotification for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: PutBucketNotificationWithContext has been deprecated
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketNotificationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketNotificationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketNotificationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketNotificationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketNotificationConfiguration = "PutBucketNotificationConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketNotificationConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketNotificationConfiguration for more information on using the PutBucketNotificationConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketNotificationConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest(input *PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketNotificationConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketNotificationConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?notification",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketNotificationConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketNotificationConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Enables notifications of specified events for a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketNotificationConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketNotificationConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketNotificationConfiguration(input *PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput) (*PutBucketNotificationConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketNotificationConfigurationWithContext is the same as PutBucketNotificationConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketNotificationConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketNotificationConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketNotificationConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketPolicy = "PutBucketPolicy"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketPolicyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketPolicy operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketPolicy for more information on using the PutBucketPolicy
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketPolicyRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketPolicyRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketPolicy
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketPolicyRequest(input *PutBucketPolicyInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketPolicyOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketPolicy,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?policy",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketPolicyInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketPolicyOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketPolicy API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Replaces a policy on a bucket. If the bucket already has a policy, the one
|
|
// in this request completely replaces it.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketPolicy for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketPolicy
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketPolicy(input *PutBucketPolicyInput) (*PutBucketPolicyOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketPolicyRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketPolicyWithContext is the same as PutBucketPolicy with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketPolicy for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketPolicyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketPolicyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketPolicyOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketPolicyRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketReplication = "PutBucketReplication"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketReplicationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketReplication operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketReplication for more information on using the PutBucketReplication
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketReplicationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketReplicationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketReplication
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketReplicationRequest(input *PutBucketReplicationInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketReplicationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketReplication,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?replication",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketReplicationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketReplicationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketReplication API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a replication configuration or replaces an existing one. For more
|
|
// information, see Cross-Region Replication (CRR) ( https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/crr.html)
|
|
// in the Amazon S3 Developer Guide.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketReplication for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketReplication
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketReplication(input *PutBucketReplicationInput) (*PutBucketReplicationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketReplicationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketReplicationWithContext is the same as PutBucketReplication with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketReplication for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketReplicationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketReplicationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketReplicationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketReplicationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketRequestPayment = "PutBucketRequestPayment"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketRequestPaymentRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketRequestPayment operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketRequestPayment for more information on using the PutBucketRequestPayment
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketRequestPaymentRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketRequestPaymentRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketRequestPayment
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketRequestPaymentRequest(input *PutBucketRequestPaymentInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketRequestPaymentOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketRequestPayment,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?requestPayment",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketRequestPaymentInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketRequestPaymentOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketRequestPayment API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Sets the request payment configuration for a bucket. By default, the bucket
|
|
// owner pays for downloads from the bucket. This configuration parameter enables
|
|
// the bucket owner (only) to specify that the person requesting the download
|
|
// will be charged for the download. Documentation on requester pays buckets
|
|
// can be found at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/RequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketRequestPayment for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketRequestPayment
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketRequestPayment(input *PutBucketRequestPaymentInput) (*PutBucketRequestPaymentOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketRequestPaymentRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketRequestPaymentWithContext is the same as PutBucketRequestPayment with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketRequestPayment for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketRequestPaymentWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketRequestPaymentInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketRequestPaymentOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketRequestPaymentRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketTagging = "PutBucketTagging"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketTaggingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketTagging operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketTagging for more information on using the PutBucketTagging
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketTaggingRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketTaggingRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketTagging
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketTaggingRequest(input *PutBucketTaggingInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketTaggingOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketTagging,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?tagging",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketTaggingInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketTaggingOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketTagging API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Sets the tags for a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketTagging for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketTagging
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketTagging(input *PutBucketTaggingInput) (*PutBucketTaggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketTaggingRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketTaggingWithContext is the same as PutBucketTagging with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketTagging for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketTaggingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketTaggingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketTaggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketTaggingRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketVersioning = "PutBucketVersioning"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketVersioningRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketVersioning operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketVersioning for more information on using the PutBucketVersioning
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketVersioningRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketVersioningRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketVersioning
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketVersioningRequest(input *PutBucketVersioningInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketVersioningOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketVersioning,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?versioning",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketVersioningInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketVersioningOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketVersioning API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Sets the versioning state of an existing bucket. To set the versioning state,
|
|
// you must be the bucket owner.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketVersioning for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketVersioning
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketVersioning(input *PutBucketVersioningInput) (*PutBucketVersioningOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketVersioningRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketVersioningWithContext is the same as PutBucketVersioning with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketVersioning for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketVersioningWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketVersioningInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketVersioningOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketVersioningRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutBucketWebsite = "PutBucketWebsite"
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketWebsiteRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutBucketWebsite operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketWebsite for more information on using the PutBucketWebsite
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutBucketWebsiteRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutBucketWebsiteRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketWebsite
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketWebsiteRequest(input *PutBucketWebsiteInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutBucketWebsiteOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutBucketWebsite,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?website",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutBucketWebsiteInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutBucketWebsiteOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketWebsite API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Set the website configuration for a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutBucketWebsite for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutBucketWebsite
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketWebsite(input *PutBucketWebsiteInput) (*PutBucketWebsiteOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketWebsiteRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutBucketWebsiteWithContext is the same as PutBucketWebsite with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutBucketWebsite for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutBucketWebsiteWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutBucketWebsiteInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutBucketWebsiteOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutBucketWebsiteRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutObject = "PutObject"
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutObject operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutObject for more information on using the PutObject
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutObjectRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutObjectRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutObject
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectRequest(input *PutObjectInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutObjectOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutObject,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutObjectInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutObjectOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutObject API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Adds an object to a bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutObject for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutObject
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObject(input *PutObjectInput) (*PutObjectOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutObjectRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectWithContext is the same as PutObject with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutObject for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutObjectInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutObjectOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutObjectRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutObjectAcl = "PutObjectAcl"
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectAclRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutObjectAcl operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutObjectAcl for more information on using the PutObjectAcl
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutObjectAclRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutObjectAclRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutObjectAcl
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectAclRequest(input *PutObjectAclInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutObjectAclOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutObjectAcl,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}?acl",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutObjectAclInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutObjectAclOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectAcl API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// uses the acl subresource to set the access control list (ACL) permissions
|
|
// for an object that already exists in a bucket
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutObjectAcl for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeNoSuchKey "NoSuchKey"
|
|
// The specified key does not exist.
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutObjectAcl
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectAcl(input *PutObjectAclInput) (*PutObjectAclOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutObjectAclRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectAclWithContext is the same as PutObjectAcl with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutObjectAcl for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectAclWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutObjectAclInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutObjectAclOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutObjectAclRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutObjectLegalHold = "PutObjectLegalHold"
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectLegalHoldRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutObjectLegalHold operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutObjectLegalHold for more information on using the PutObjectLegalHold
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutObjectLegalHoldRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutObjectLegalHoldRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutObjectLegalHold
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectLegalHoldRequest(input *PutObjectLegalHoldInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutObjectLegalHoldOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutObjectLegalHold,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}?legal-hold",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutObjectLegalHoldInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutObjectLegalHoldOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectLegalHold API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Applies a Legal Hold configuration to the specified object.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutObjectLegalHold for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutObjectLegalHold
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectLegalHold(input *PutObjectLegalHoldInput) (*PutObjectLegalHoldOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutObjectLegalHoldRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectLegalHoldWithContext is the same as PutObjectLegalHold with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutObjectLegalHold for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectLegalHoldWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutObjectLegalHoldInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutObjectLegalHoldOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutObjectLegalHoldRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutObjectLockConfiguration = "PutObjectLockConfiguration"
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectLockConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutObjectLockConfiguration operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutObjectLockConfiguration for more information on using the PutObjectLockConfiguration
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutObjectLockConfigurationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutObjectLockConfigurationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutObjectLockConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectLockConfigurationRequest(input *PutObjectLockConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutObjectLockConfigurationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutObjectLockConfiguration,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?object-lock",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutObjectLockConfigurationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutObjectLockConfigurationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectLockConfiguration API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Places an Object Lock configuration on the specified bucket. The rule specified
|
|
// in the Object Lock configuration will be applied by default to every new
|
|
// object placed in the specified bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutObjectLockConfiguration for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutObjectLockConfiguration
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectLockConfiguration(input *PutObjectLockConfigurationInput) (*PutObjectLockConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutObjectLockConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectLockConfigurationWithContext is the same as PutObjectLockConfiguration with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutObjectLockConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectLockConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutObjectLockConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutObjectLockConfigurationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutObjectLockConfigurationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutObjectRetention = "PutObjectRetention"
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectRetentionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutObjectRetention operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutObjectRetention for more information on using the PutObjectRetention
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutObjectRetentionRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutObjectRetentionRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutObjectRetention
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectRetentionRequest(input *PutObjectRetentionInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutObjectRetentionOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutObjectRetention,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}?retention",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutObjectRetentionInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutObjectRetentionOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectRetention API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Places an Object Retention configuration on an object.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutObjectRetention for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutObjectRetention
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectRetention(input *PutObjectRetentionInput) (*PutObjectRetentionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutObjectRetentionRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectRetentionWithContext is the same as PutObjectRetention with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutObjectRetention for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectRetentionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutObjectRetentionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutObjectRetentionOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutObjectRetentionRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutObjectTagging = "PutObjectTagging"
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectTaggingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutObjectTagging operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutObjectTagging for more information on using the PutObjectTagging
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutObjectTaggingRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutObjectTaggingRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutObjectTagging
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectTaggingRequest(input *PutObjectTaggingInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutObjectTaggingOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutObjectTagging,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}?tagging",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutObjectTaggingInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutObjectTaggingOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectTagging API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Sets the supplied tag-set to an object that already exists in a bucket
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutObjectTagging for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutObjectTagging
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectTagging(input *PutObjectTaggingInput) (*PutObjectTaggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutObjectTaggingRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutObjectTaggingWithContext is the same as PutObjectTagging with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutObjectTagging for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutObjectTaggingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutObjectTaggingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutObjectTaggingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutObjectTaggingRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPutPublicAccessBlock = "PutPublicAccessBlock"
|
|
|
|
// PutPublicAccessBlockRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PutPublicAccessBlock operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutPublicAccessBlock for more information on using the PutPublicAccessBlock
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PutPublicAccessBlockRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PutPublicAccessBlockRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutPublicAccessBlock
|
|
func (c *S3) PutPublicAccessBlockRequest(input *PutPublicAccessBlockInput) (req *request.Request, output *PutPublicAccessBlockOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPutPublicAccessBlock,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}?publicAccessBlock",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PutPublicAccessBlockInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PutPublicAccessBlockOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutPublicAccessBlock API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates or modifies the PublicAccessBlock configuration for an Amazon S3
|
|
// bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation PutPublicAccessBlock for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/PutPublicAccessBlock
|
|
func (c *S3) PutPublicAccessBlock(input *PutPublicAccessBlockInput) (*PutPublicAccessBlockOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutPublicAccessBlockRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PutPublicAccessBlockWithContext is the same as PutPublicAccessBlock with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PutPublicAccessBlock for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) PutPublicAccessBlockWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PutPublicAccessBlockInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PutPublicAccessBlockOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PutPublicAccessBlockRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opRestoreObject = "RestoreObject"
|
|
|
|
// RestoreObjectRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the RestoreObject operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See RestoreObject for more information on using the RestoreObject
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the RestoreObjectRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.RestoreObjectRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/RestoreObject
|
|
func (c *S3) RestoreObjectRequest(input *RestoreObjectInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreObjectOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opRestoreObject,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}?restore",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &RestoreObjectInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &RestoreObjectOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// RestoreObject API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Restores an archived copy of an object back into Amazon S3
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation RestoreObject for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeObjectAlreadyInActiveTierError "ObjectAlreadyInActiveTierError"
|
|
// This operation is not allowed against this storage tier
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/RestoreObject
|
|
func (c *S3) RestoreObject(input *RestoreObjectInput) (*RestoreObjectOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.RestoreObjectRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// RestoreObjectWithContext is the same as RestoreObject with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See RestoreObject for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) RestoreObjectWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreObjectInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreObjectOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.RestoreObjectRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opSelectObjectContent = "SelectObjectContent"
|
|
|
|
// SelectObjectContentRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the SelectObjectContent operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See SelectObjectContent for more information on using the SelectObjectContent
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the SelectObjectContentRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.SelectObjectContentRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/SelectObjectContent
|
|
func (c *S3) SelectObjectContentRequest(input *SelectObjectContentInput) (req *request.Request, output *SelectObjectContentOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opSelectObjectContent,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}?select&select-type=2",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &SelectObjectContentInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &SelectObjectContentOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Send.Swap(client.LogHTTPResponseHandler.Name, client.LogHTTPResponseHeaderHandler)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restxml.UnmarshalHandler.Name, rest.UnmarshalHandler)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.PushBack(output.runEventStreamLoop)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SelectObjectContent API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// This operation filters the contents of an Amazon S3 object based on a simple
|
|
// Structured Query Language (SQL) statement. In the request, along with the
|
|
// SQL expression, you must also specify a data serialization format (JSON or
|
|
// CSV) of the object. Amazon S3 uses this to parse object data into records,
|
|
// and returns only records that match the specified SQL expression. You must
|
|
// also specify the data serialization format for the response.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation SelectObjectContent for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/SelectObjectContent
|
|
func (c *S3) SelectObjectContent(input *SelectObjectContentInput) (*SelectObjectContentOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.SelectObjectContentRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SelectObjectContentWithContext is the same as SelectObjectContent with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See SelectObjectContent for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) SelectObjectContentWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *SelectObjectContentInput, opts ...request.Option) (*SelectObjectContentOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.SelectObjectContentRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUploadPart = "UploadPart"
|
|
|
|
// UploadPartRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UploadPart operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UploadPart for more information on using the UploadPart
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UploadPartRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UploadPartRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/UploadPart
|
|
func (c *S3) UploadPartRequest(input *UploadPartInput) (req *request.Request, output *UploadPartOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUploadPart,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UploadPartInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UploadPartOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UploadPart API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Uploads a part in a multipart upload.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: After you initiate multipart upload and upload one or more parts, you
|
|
// must either complete or abort multipart upload in order to stop getting charged
|
|
// for storage of the uploaded parts. Only after you either complete or abort
|
|
// multipart upload, Amazon S3 frees up the parts storage and stops charging
|
|
// you for the parts storage.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation UploadPart for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/UploadPart
|
|
func (c *S3) UploadPart(input *UploadPartInput) (*UploadPartOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UploadPartRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UploadPartWithContext is the same as UploadPart with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UploadPart for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) UploadPartWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UploadPartInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UploadPartOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UploadPartRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUploadPartCopy = "UploadPartCopy"
|
|
|
|
// UploadPartCopyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UploadPartCopy operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UploadPartCopy for more information on using the UploadPartCopy
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UploadPartCopyRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UploadPartCopyRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/UploadPartCopy
|
|
func (c *S3) UploadPartCopyRequest(input *UploadPartCopyInput) (req *request.Request, output *UploadPartCopyOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUploadPartCopy,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/{Bucket}/{Key+}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UploadPartCopyInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UploadPartCopyOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UploadPartCopy API operation for Amazon Simple Storage Service.
|
|
//
|
|
// Uploads a part by copying data from an existing object as data source.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Simple Storage Service's
|
|
// API operation UploadPartCopy for usage and error information.
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/s3-2006-03-01/UploadPartCopy
|
|
func (c *S3) UploadPartCopy(input *UploadPartCopyInput) (*UploadPartCopyOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UploadPartCopyRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UploadPartCopyWithContext is the same as UploadPartCopy with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UploadPartCopy for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *S3) UploadPartCopyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UploadPartCopyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UploadPartCopyOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UploadPartCopyRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the days since the initiation of an Incomplete Multipart Upload
|
|
// that Lifecycle will wait before permanently removing all parts of the upload.
|
|
type AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates the number of days that must pass since initiation for Lifecycle
|
|
// to abort an Incomplete Multipart Upload.
|
|
DaysAfterInitiation *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDaysAfterInitiation sets the DaysAfterInitiation field's value.
|
|
func (s *AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload) SetDaysAfterInitiation(v int64) *AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload {
|
|
s.DaysAfterInitiation = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AbortMultipartUploadInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// UploadId is a required field
|
|
UploadId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"uploadId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AbortMultipartUploadInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AbortMultipartUploadInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AbortMultipartUploadInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AbortMultipartUploadInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.UploadId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UploadId"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *AbortMultipartUploadInput) SetBucket(v string) *AbortMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *AbortMultipartUploadInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *AbortMultipartUploadInput) SetKey(v string) *AbortMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *AbortMultipartUploadInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *AbortMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUploadId sets the UploadId field's value.
|
|
func (s *AbortMultipartUploadInput) SetUploadId(v string) *AbortMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.UploadId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AbortMultipartUploadOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AbortMultipartUploadOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AbortMultipartUploadOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *AbortMultipartUploadOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *AbortMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AccelerateConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The accelerate configuration of the bucket.
|
|
Status *string `type:"string" enum:"BucketAccelerateStatus"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AccelerateConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AccelerateConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
|
|
func (s *AccelerateConfiguration) SetStatus(v string) *AccelerateConfiguration {
|
|
s.Status = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AccessControlPolicy struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of grants.
|
|
Grants []*Grant `locationName:"AccessControlList" locationNameList:"Grant" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
Owner *Owner `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AccessControlPolicy) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AccessControlPolicy) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AccessControlPolicy) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AccessControlPolicy"}
|
|
if s.Grants != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Grants {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Grants", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrants sets the Grants field's value.
|
|
func (s *AccessControlPolicy) SetGrants(v []*Grant) *AccessControlPolicy {
|
|
s.Grants = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwner sets the Owner field's value.
|
|
func (s *AccessControlPolicy) SetOwner(v *Owner) *AccessControlPolicy {
|
|
s.Owner = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for information about access control for replicas.
|
|
type AccessControlTranslation struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The override value for the owner of the replica object.
|
|
//
|
|
// Owner is a required field
|
|
Owner *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"OwnerOverride"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AccessControlTranslation) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AccessControlTranslation) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AccessControlTranslation) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AccessControlTranslation"}
|
|
if s.Owner == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Owner"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwner sets the Owner field's value.
|
|
func (s *AccessControlTranslation) SetOwner(v string) *AccessControlTranslation {
|
|
s.Owner = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AnalyticsAndOperator struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The prefix to use when evaluating an AND predicate.
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The list of tags to use when evaluating an AND predicate.
|
|
Tags []*Tag `locationName:"Tag" locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AnalyticsAndOperator) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AnalyticsAndOperator) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsAndOperator) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AnalyticsAndOperator"}
|
|
if s.Tags != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Tags {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Tags", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsAndOperator) SetPrefix(v string) *AnalyticsAndOperator {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsAndOperator) SetTags(v []*Tag) *AnalyticsAndOperator {
|
|
s.Tags = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AnalyticsConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The filter used to describe a set of objects for analyses. A filter must
|
|
// have exactly one prefix, one tag, or one conjunction (AnalyticsAndOperator).
|
|
// If no filter is provided, all objects will be considered in any analysis.
|
|
Filter *AnalyticsFilter `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The identifier used to represent an analytics configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Id is a required field
|
|
Id *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, it indicates that data related to access patterns will be collected
|
|
// and made available to analyze the tradeoffs between different storage classes.
|
|
//
|
|
// StorageClassAnalysis is a required field
|
|
StorageClassAnalysis *StorageClassAnalysis `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AnalyticsConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AnalyticsConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AnalyticsConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.Id == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.StorageClassAnalysis == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("StorageClassAnalysis"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Filter != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Filter.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Filter", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.StorageClassAnalysis != nil {
|
|
if err := s.StorageClassAnalysis.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("StorageClassAnalysis", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilter sets the Filter field's value.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsConfiguration) SetFilter(v *AnalyticsFilter) *AnalyticsConfiguration {
|
|
s.Filter = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsConfiguration) SetId(v string) *AnalyticsConfiguration {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClassAnalysis sets the StorageClassAnalysis field's value.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsConfiguration) SetStorageClassAnalysis(v *StorageClassAnalysis) *AnalyticsConfiguration {
|
|
s.StorageClassAnalysis = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AnalyticsExportDestination struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A destination signifying output to an S3 bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// S3BucketDestination is a required field
|
|
S3BucketDestination *AnalyticsS3BucketDestination `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AnalyticsExportDestination) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AnalyticsExportDestination) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsExportDestination) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AnalyticsExportDestination"}
|
|
if s.S3BucketDestination == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("S3BucketDestination"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.S3BucketDestination != nil {
|
|
if err := s.S3BucketDestination.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("S3BucketDestination", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetS3BucketDestination sets the S3BucketDestination field's value.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsExportDestination) SetS3BucketDestination(v *AnalyticsS3BucketDestination) *AnalyticsExportDestination {
|
|
s.S3BucketDestination = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AnalyticsFilter struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A conjunction (logical AND) of predicates, which is used in evaluating an
|
|
// analytics filter. The operator must have at least two predicates.
|
|
And *AnalyticsAndOperator `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The prefix to use when evaluating an analytics filter.
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The tag to use when evaluating an analytics filter.
|
|
Tag *Tag `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AnalyticsFilter) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AnalyticsFilter) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsFilter) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AnalyticsFilter"}
|
|
if s.And != nil {
|
|
if err := s.And.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("And", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Tag != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Tag.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Tag", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAnd sets the And field's value.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsFilter) SetAnd(v *AnalyticsAndOperator) *AnalyticsFilter {
|
|
s.And = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsFilter) SetPrefix(v string) *AnalyticsFilter {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTag sets the Tag field's value.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsFilter) SetTag(v *Tag) *AnalyticsFilter {
|
|
s.Tag = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AnalyticsS3BucketDestination struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The Amazon resource name (ARN) of the bucket to which data is exported.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The account ID that owns the destination bucket. If no account ID is provided,
|
|
// the owner will not be validated prior to exporting data.
|
|
BucketAccountId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The file format used when exporting data to Amazon S3.
|
|
//
|
|
// Format is a required field
|
|
Format *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"AnalyticsS3ExportFileFormat"`
|
|
|
|
// The prefix to use when exporting data. The exported data begins with this
|
|
// prefix.
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AnalyticsS3BucketDestination) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AnalyticsS3BucketDestination) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsS3BucketDestination) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AnalyticsS3BucketDestination"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Format == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Format"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsS3BucketDestination) SetBucket(v string) *AnalyticsS3BucketDestination {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsS3BucketDestination) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucketAccountId sets the BucketAccountId field's value.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsS3BucketDestination) SetBucketAccountId(v string) *AnalyticsS3BucketDestination {
|
|
s.BucketAccountId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFormat sets the Format field's value.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsS3BucketDestination) SetFormat(v string) *AnalyticsS3BucketDestination {
|
|
s.Format = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *AnalyticsS3BucketDestination) SetPrefix(v string) *AnalyticsS3BucketDestination {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Bucket struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Date the bucket was created.
|
|
CreationDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket.
|
|
Name *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Bucket) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Bucket) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreationDate sets the CreationDate field's value.
|
|
func (s *Bucket) SetCreationDate(v time.Time) *Bucket {
|
|
s.CreationDate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *Bucket) SetName(v string) *Bucket {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BucketLifecycleConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Rules is a required field
|
|
Rules []*LifecycleRule `locationName:"Rule" type:"list" flattened:"true" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BucketLifecycleConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BucketLifecycleConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BucketLifecycleConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BucketLifecycleConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.Rules == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Rules"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Rules != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Rules {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Rules", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRules sets the Rules field's value.
|
|
func (s *BucketLifecycleConfiguration) SetRules(v []*LifecycleRule) *BucketLifecycleConfiguration {
|
|
s.Rules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BucketLoggingStatus struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Container for logging information. Presence of this element indicates that
|
|
// logging is enabled. Parameters TargetBucket and TargetPrefix are required
|
|
// in this case.
|
|
LoggingEnabled *LoggingEnabled `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BucketLoggingStatus) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BucketLoggingStatus) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BucketLoggingStatus) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BucketLoggingStatus"}
|
|
if s.LoggingEnabled != nil {
|
|
if err := s.LoggingEnabled.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("LoggingEnabled", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLoggingEnabled sets the LoggingEnabled field's value.
|
|
func (s *BucketLoggingStatus) SetLoggingEnabled(v *LoggingEnabled) *BucketLoggingStatus {
|
|
s.LoggingEnabled = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CORSConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// CORSRules is a required field
|
|
CORSRules []*CORSRule `locationName:"CORSRule" type:"list" flattened:"true" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CORSConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CORSConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CORSConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CORSConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.CORSRules == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CORSRules"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CORSRules != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.CORSRules {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "CORSRules", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCORSRules sets the CORSRules field's value.
|
|
func (s *CORSConfiguration) SetCORSRules(v []*CORSRule) *CORSConfiguration {
|
|
s.CORSRules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CORSRule struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies which headers are allowed in a pre-flight OPTIONS request.
|
|
AllowedHeaders []*string `locationName:"AllowedHeader" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Identifies HTTP methods that the domain/origin specified in the rule is allowed
|
|
// to execute.
|
|
//
|
|
// AllowedMethods is a required field
|
|
AllowedMethods []*string `locationName:"AllowedMethod" type:"list" flattened:"true" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// One or more origins you want customers to be able to access the bucket from.
|
|
//
|
|
// AllowedOrigins is a required field
|
|
AllowedOrigins []*string `locationName:"AllowedOrigin" type:"list" flattened:"true" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// One or more headers in the response that you want customers to be able to
|
|
// access from their applications (for example, from a JavaScript XMLHttpRequest
|
|
// object).
|
|
ExposeHeaders []*string `locationName:"ExposeHeader" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The time in seconds that your browser is to cache the preflight response
|
|
// for the specified resource.
|
|
MaxAgeSeconds *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CORSRule) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CORSRule) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CORSRule) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CORSRule"}
|
|
if s.AllowedMethods == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AllowedMethods"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.AllowedOrigins == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AllowedOrigins"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAllowedHeaders sets the AllowedHeaders field's value.
|
|
func (s *CORSRule) SetAllowedHeaders(v []*string) *CORSRule {
|
|
s.AllowedHeaders = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAllowedMethods sets the AllowedMethods field's value.
|
|
func (s *CORSRule) SetAllowedMethods(v []*string) *CORSRule {
|
|
s.AllowedMethods = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAllowedOrigins sets the AllowedOrigins field's value.
|
|
func (s *CORSRule) SetAllowedOrigins(v []*string) *CORSRule {
|
|
s.AllowedOrigins = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExposeHeaders sets the ExposeHeaders field's value.
|
|
func (s *CORSRule) SetExposeHeaders(v []*string) *CORSRule {
|
|
s.ExposeHeaders = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxAgeSeconds sets the MaxAgeSeconds field's value.
|
|
func (s *CORSRule) SetMaxAgeSeconds(v int64) *CORSRule {
|
|
s.MaxAgeSeconds = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Describes how a CSV-formatted input object is formatted.
|
|
type CSVInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies that CSV field values may contain quoted record delimiters and
|
|
// such records should be allowed. Default value is FALSE. Setting this value
|
|
// to TRUE may lower performance.
|
|
AllowQuotedRecordDelimiter *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The single character used to indicate a row should be ignored when present
|
|
// at the start of a row.
|
|
Comments *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The value used to separate individual fields in a record.
|
|
FieldDelimiter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Describes the first line of input. Valid values: None, Ignore, Use.
|
|
FileHeaderInfo *string `type:"string" enum:"FileHeaderInfo"`
|
|
|
|
// Value used for escaping where the field delimiter is part of the value.
|
|
QuoteCharacter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The single character used for escaping the quote character inside an already
|
|
// escaped value.
|
|
QuoteEscapeCharacter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The value used to separate individual records.
|
|
RecordDelimiter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CSVInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CSVInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAllowQuotedRecordDelimiter sets the AllowQuotedRecordDelimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *CSVInput) SetAllowQuotedRecordDelimiter(v bool) *CSVInput {
|
|
s.AllowQuotedRecordDelimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetComments sets the Comments field's value.
|
|
func (s *CSVInput) SetComments(v string) *CSVInput {
|
|
s.Comments = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFieldDelimiter sets the FieldDelimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *CSVInput) SetFieldDelimiter(v string) *CSVInput {
|
|
s.FieldDelimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFileHeaderInfo sets the FileHeaderInfo field's value.
|
|
func (s *CSVInput) SetFileHeaderInfo(v string) *CSVInput {
|
|
s.FileHeaderInfo = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetQuoteCharacter sets the QuoteCharacter field's value.
|
|
func (s *CSVInput) SetQuoteCharacter(v string) *CSVInput {
|
|
s.QuoteCharacter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetQuoteEscapeCharacter sets the QuoteEscapeCharacter field's value.
|
|
func (s *CSVInput) SetQuoteEscapeCharacter(v string) *CSVInput {
|
|
s.QuoteEscapeCharacter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRecordDelimiter sets the RecordDelimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *CSVInput) SetRecordDelimiter(v string) *CSVInput {
|
|
s.RecordDelimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Describes how CSV-formatted results are formatted.
|
|
type CSVOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The value used to separate individual fields in a record.
|
|
FieldDelimiter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The value used for escaping where the field delimiter is part of the value.
|
|
QuoteCharacter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Th single character used for escaping the quote character inside an already
|
|
// escaped value.
|
|
QuoteEscapeCharacter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether or not all output fields should be quoted.
|
|
QuoteFields *string `type:"string" enum:"QuoteFields"`
|
|
|
|
// The value used to separate individual records.
|
|
RecordDelimiter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CSVOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CSVOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFieldDelimiter sets the FieldDelimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *CSVOutput) SetFieldDelimiter(v string) *CSVOutput {
|
|
s.FieldDelimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetQuoteCharacter sets the QuoteCharacter field's value.
|
|
func (s *CSVOutput) SetQuoteCharacter(v string) *CSVOutput {
|
|
s.QuoteCharacter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetQuoteEscapeCharacter sets the QuoteEscapeCharacter field's value.
|
|
func (s *CSVOutput) SetQuoteEscapeCharacter(v string) *CSVOutput {
|
|
s.QuoteEscapeCharacter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetQuoteFields sets the QuoteFields field's value.
|
|
func (s *CSVOutput) SetQuoteFields(v string) *CSVOutput {
|
|
s.QuoteFields = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRecordDelimiter sets the RecordDelimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *CSVOutput) SetRecordDelimiter(v string) *CSVOutput {
|
|
s.RecordDelimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CloudFunctionConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
CloudFunction *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The bucket event for which to send notifications.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: Event has been deprecated
|
|
Event *string `deprecated:"true" type:"string" enum:"Event"`
|
|
|
|
Events []*string `locationName:"Event" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// An optional unique identifier for configurations in a notification configuration.
|
|
// If you don't provide one, Amazon S3 will assign an ID.
|
|
Id *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
InvocationRole *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CloudFunctionConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CloudFunctionConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCloudFunction sets the CloudFunction field's value.
|
|
func (s *CloudFunctionConfiguration) SetCloudFunction(v string) *CloudFunctionConfiguration {
|
|
s.CloudFunction = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEvent sets the Event field's value.
|
|
func (s *CloudFunctionConfiguration) SetEvent(v string) *CloudFunctionConfiguration {
|
|
s.Event = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEvents sets the Events field's value.
|
|
func (s *CloudFunctionConfiguration) SetEvents(v []*string) *CloudFunctionConfiguration {
|
|
s.Events = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *CloudFunctionConfiguration) SetId(v string) *CloudFunctionConfiguration {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInvocationRole sets the InvocationRole field's value.
|
|
func (s *CloudFunctionConfiguration) SetInvocationRole(v string) *CloudFunctionConfiguration {
|
|
s.InvocationRole = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CommonPrefix struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CommonPrefix) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CommonPrefix) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *CommonPrefix) SetPrefix(v string) *CommonPrefix {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CompleteMultipartUploadInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"MultipartUpload"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
MultipartUpload *CompletedMultipartUpload `locationName:"CompleteMultipartUpload" type:"structure" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// UploadId is a required field
|
|
UploadId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"uploadId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CompleteMultipartUploadInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CompleteMultipartUploadInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CompleteMultipartUploadInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.UploadId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UploadId"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadInput) SetBucket(v string) *CompleteMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadInput) SetKey(v string) *CompleteMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMultipartUpload sets the MultipartUpload field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadInput) SetMultipartUpload(v *CompletedMultipartUpload) *CompleteMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.MultipartUpload = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *CompleteMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUploadId sets the UploadId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadInput) SetUploadId(v string) *CompleteMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.UploadId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CompleteMultipartUploadOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Bucket *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Entity tag of the object.
|
|
ETag *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the object expiration is configured, this will contain the expiration
|
|
// date (expiry-date) and rule ID (rule-id). The value of rule-id is URL encoded.
|
|
Expiration *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-expiration" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Key *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Location *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, specifies the ID of the AWS Key Management Service (KMS) master
|
|
// encryption key that was used for the object.
|
|
SSEKMSKeyId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The Server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
|
|
// (e.g., AES256, aws:kms).
|
|
ServerSideEncryption *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption" type:"string" enum:"ServerSideEncryption"`
|
|
|
|
// Version of the object.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-version-id" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CompleteMultipartUploadOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CompleteMultipartUploadOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput) SetBucket(v string) *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetETag sets the ETag field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput) SetETag(v string) *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.ETag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpiration sets the Expiration field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput) SetExpiration(v string) *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.Expiration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput) SetKey(v string) *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLocation sets the Location field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput) SetLocation(v string) *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.Location = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSEKMSKeyId sets the SSEKMSKeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput) SetSSEKMSKeyId(v string) *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.SSEKMSKeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerSideEncryption sets the ServerSideEncryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput) SetServerSideEncryption(v string) *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.ServerSideEncryption = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput) SetVersionId(v string) *CompleteMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CompletedMultipartUpload struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Parts []*CompletedPart `locationName:"Part" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CompletedMultipartUpload) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CompletedMultipartUpload) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParts sets the Parts field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompletedMultipartUpload) SetParts(v []*CompletedPart) *CompletedMultipartUpload {
|
|
s.Parts = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CompletedPart struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Entity tag returned when the part was uploaded.
|
|
ETag *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Part number that identifies the part. This is a positive integer between
|
|
// 1 and 10,000.
|
|
PartNumber *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CompletedPart) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CompletedPart) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetETag sets the ETag field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompletedPart) SetETag(v string) *CompletedPart {
|
|
s.ETag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartNumber sets the PartNumber field's value.
|
|
func (s *CompletedPart) SetPartNumber(v int64) *CompletedPart {
|
|
s.PartNumber = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Condition struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The HTTP error code when the redirect is applied. In the event of an error,
|
|
// if the error code equals this value, then the specified redirect is applied.
|
|
// Required when parent element Condition is specified and sibling KeyPrefixEquals
|
|
// is not specified. If both are specified, then both must be true for the redirect
|
|
// to be applied.
|
|
HttpErrorCodeReturnedEquals *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The object key name prefix when the redirect is applied. For example, to
|
|
// redirect requests for ExamplePage.html, the key prefix will be ExamplePage.html.
|
|
// To redirect request for all pages with the prefix docs/, the key prefix will
|
|
// be /docs, which identifies all objects in the docs/ folder. Required when
|
|
// the parent element Condition is specified and sibling HttpErrorCodeReturnedEquals
|
|
// is not specified. If both conditions are specified, both must be true for
|
|
// the redirect to be applied.
|
|
KeyPrefixEquals *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Condition) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Condition) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHttpErrorCodeReturnedEquals sets the HttpErrorCodeReturnedEquals field's value.
|
|
func (s *Condition) SetHttpErrorCodeReturnedEquals(v string) *Condition {
|
|
s.HttpErrorCodeReturnedEquals = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKeyPrefixEquals sets the KeyPrefixEquals field's value.
|
|
func (s *Condition) SetKeyPrefixEquals(v string) *Condition {
|
|
s.KeyPrefixEquals = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ContinuationEvent struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `locationName:"ContinuationEvent" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ContinuationEvent) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ContinuationEvent) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The ContinuationEvent is and event in the SelectObjectContentEventStream group of events.
|
|
func (s *ContinuationEvent) eventSelectObjectContentEventStream() {}
|
|
|
|
// UnmarshalEvent unmarshals the EventStream Message into the ContinuationEvent value.
|
|
// This method is only used internally within the SDK's EventStream handling.
|
|
func (s *ContinuationEvent) UnmarshalEvent(
|
|
payloadUnmarshaler protocol.PayloadUnmarshaler,
|
|
msg eventstream.Message,
|
|
) error {
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CopyObjectInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The canned ACL to apply to the object.
|
|
ACL *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-acl" type:"string" enum:"ObjectCannedACL"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies caching behavior along the request/reply chain.
|
|
CacheControl *string `location:"header" locationName:"Cache-Control" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies presentational information for the object.
|
|
ContentDisposition *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Disposition" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies what content encodings have been applied to the object and thus
|
|
// what decoding mechanisms must be applied to obtain the media-type referenced
|
|
// by the Content-Type header field.
|
|
ContentEncoding *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Encoding" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The language the content is in.
|
|
ContentLanguage *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Language" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A standard MIME type describing the format of the object data.
|
|
ContentType *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Type" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the source bucket and key name of the source object, separated
|
|
// by a slash (/). Must be URL-encoded.
|
|
//
|
|
// CopySource is a required field
|
|
CopySource *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Copies the object if its entity tag (ETag) matches the specified tag.
|
|
CopySourceIfMatch *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-if-match" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Copies the object if it has been modified since the specified time.
|
|
CopySourceIfModifiedSince *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-if-modified-since" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Copies the object if its entity tag (ETag) is different than the specified
|
|
// ETag.
|
|
CopySourceIfNoneMatch *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-if-none-match" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Copies the object if it hasn't been modified since the specified time.
|
|
CopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-if-unmodified-since" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the algorithm to use when decrypting the source object (e.g., AES256).
|
|
CopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use to decrypt
|
|
// the source object. The encryption key provided in this header must be one
|
|
// that was used when the source object was created.
|
|
CopySourceSSECustomerKey *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-server-side-encryption-customer-key" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321.
|
|
// Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure the encryption
|
|
// key was transmitted without error.
|
|
CopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The date and time at which the object is no longer cacheable.
|
|
Expires *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"Expires" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Gives the grantee READ, READ_ACP, and WRITE_ACP permissions on the object.
|
|
GrantFullControl *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-full-control" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to read the object data and its metadata.
|
|
GrantRead *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-read" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to read the object ACL.
|
|
GrantReadACP *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-read-acp" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to write the ACL for the applicable object.
|
|
GrantWriteACP *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-write-acp" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A map of metadata to store with the object in S3.
|
|
Metadata map[string]*string `location:"headers" locationName:"x-amz-meta-" type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether the metadata is copied from the source object or replaced
|
|
// with metadata provided in the request.
|
|
MetadataDirective *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-metadata-directive" type:"string" enum:"MetadataDirective"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether you want to apply a Legal Hold to the copied object.
|
|
ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-legal-hold" type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus"`
|
|
|
|
// The Object Lock mode that you want to apply to the copied object.
|
|
ObjectLockMode *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-mode" type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockMode"`
|
|
|
|
// The date and time when you want the copied object's Object Lock to expire.
|
|
ObjectLockRetainUntilDate *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-retain-until-date" type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the algorithm to use to when encrypting the object (e.g., AES256).
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting
|
|
// data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded; Amazon
|
|
// does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with
|
|
// the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm
|
|
// header.
|
|
SSECustomerKey *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321.
|
|
// Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure the encryption
|
|
// key was transmitted without error.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the AWS KMS key ID to use for object encryption. All GET and PUT
|
|
// requests for an object protected by AWS KMS will fail if not made via SSL
|
|
// or using SigV4. Documentation on configuring any of the officially supported
|
|
// AWS SDKs and CLI can be found at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/UsingAWSSDK.html#specify-signature-version
|
|
SSEKMSKeyId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The Server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
|
|
// (e.g., AES256, aws:kms).
|
|
ServerSideEncryption *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption" type:"string" enum:"ServerSideEncryption"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of storage to use for the object. Defaults to 'STANDARD'.
|
|
StorageClass *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-storage-class" type:"string" enum:"StorageClass"`
|
|
|
|
// The tag-set for the object destination object this value must be used in
|
|
// conjunction with the TaggingDirective. The tag-set must be encoded as URL
|
|
// Query parameters
|
|
Tagging *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-tagging" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether the object tag-set are copied from the source object or
|
|
// replaced with tag-set provided in the request.
|
|
TaggingDirective *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-tagging-directive" type:"string" enum:"TaggingDirective"`
|
|
|
|
// If the bucket is configured as a website, redirects requests for this object
|
|
// to another object in the same bucket or to an external URL. Amazon S3 stores
|
|
// the value of this header in the object metadata.
|
|
WebsiteRedirectLocation *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-website-redirect-location" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CopyObjectInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CopyObjectInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CopyObjectInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CopySource == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CopySource"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetACL sets the ACL field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetACL(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.ACL = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetBucket(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCacheControl sets the CacheControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetCacheControl(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.CacheControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentDisposition sets the ContentDisposition field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetContentDisposition(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.ContentDisposition = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentEncoding sets the ContentEncoding field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetContentEncoding(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.ContentEncoding = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentLanguage sets the ContentLanguage field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetContentLanguage(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.ContentLanguage = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentType sets the ContentType field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetContentType(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.ContentType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySource sets the CopySource field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetCopySource(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.CopySource = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceIfMatch sets the CopySourceIfMatch field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetCopySourceIfMatch(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceIfMatch = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceIfModifiedSince sets the CopySourceIfModifiedSince field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetCopySourceIfModifiedSince(v time.Time) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceIfModifiedSince = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceIfNoneMatch sets the CopySourceIfNoneMatch field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetCopySourceIfNoneMatch(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceIfNoneMatch = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince sets the CopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetCopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince(v time.Time) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the CopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetCopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceSSECustomerKey sets the CopySourceSSECustomerKey field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetCopySourceSSECustomerKey(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceSSECustomerKey = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) getCopySourceSSECustomerKey() (v string) {
|
|
if s.CopySourceSSECustomerKey == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.CopySourceSSECustomerKey
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the CopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetCopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpires sets the Expires field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetExpires(v time.Time) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.Expires = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantFullControl sets the GrantFullControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetGrantFullControl(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.GrantFullControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantRead sets the GrantRead field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetGrantRead(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.GrantRead = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantReadACP sets the GrantReadACP field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetGrantReadACP(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.GrantReadACP = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantWriteACP sets the GrantWriteACP field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetGrantWriteACP(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.GrantWriteACP = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetKey(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMetadata sets the Metadata field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetMetadata(v map[string]*string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.Metadata = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMetadataDirective sets the MetadataDirective field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetMetadataDirective(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.MetadataDirective = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockLegalHoldStatus sets the ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetObjectLockLegalHoldStatus(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockMode sets the ObjectLockMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetObjectLockMode(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockRetainUntilDate sets the ObjectLockRetainUntilDate field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetObjectLockRetainUntilDate(v time.Time) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockRetainUntilDate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKey sets the SSECustomerKey field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetSSECustomerKey(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKey = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) getSSECustomerKey() (v string) {
|
|
if s.SSECustomerKey == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.SSECustomerKey
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSEKMSKeyId sets the SSEKMSKeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetSSEKMSKeyId(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSEKMSKeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerSideEncryption sets the ServerSideEncryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetServerSideEncryption(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.ServerSideEncryption = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClass sets the StorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetStorageClass(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.StorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTagging sets the Tagging field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetTagging(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.Tagging = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTaggingDirective sets the TaggingDirective field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetTaggingDirective(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.TaggingDirective = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWebsiteRedirectLocation sets the WebsiteRedirectLocation field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectInput) SetWebsiteRedirectLocation(v string) *CopyObjectInput {
|
|
s.WebsiteRedirectLocation = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CopyObjectOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"CopyObjectResult"`
|
|
|
|
CopyObjectResult *CopyObjectResult `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
CopySourceVersionId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-version-id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the object expiration is configured, the response includes this header.
|
|
Expiration *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-expiration" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header confirming the encryption algorithm
|
|
// used.
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header to provide round trip message integrity
|
|
// verification of the customer-provided encryption key.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, specifies the ID of the AWS Key Management Service (KMS) master
|
|
// encryption key that was used for the object.
|
|
SSEKMSKeyId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The Server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
|
|
// (e.g., AES256, aws:kms).
|
|
ServerSideEncryption *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption" type:"string" enum:"ServerSideEncryption"`
|
|
|
|
// Version ID of the newly created copy.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-version-id" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CopyObjectOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CopyObjectOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopyObjectResult sets the CopyObjectResult field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectOutput) SetCopyObjectResult(v *CopyObjectResult) *CopyObjectOutput {
|
|
s.CopyObjectResult = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceVersionId sets the CopySourceVersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectOutput) SetCopySourceVersionId(v string) *CopyObjectOutput {
|
|
s.CopySourceVersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpiration sets the Expiration field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectOutput) SetExpiration(v string) *CopyObjectOutput {
|
|
s.Expiration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *CopyObjectOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectOutput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *CopyObjectOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectOutput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *CopyObjectOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSEKMSKeyId sets the SSEKMSKeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectOutput) SetSSEKMSKeyId(v string) *CopyObjectOutput {
|
|
s.SSEKMSKeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerSideEncryption sets the ServerSideEncryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectOutput) SetServerSideEncryption(v string) *CopyObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ServerSideEncryption = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectOutput) SetVersionId(v string) *CopyObjectOutput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CopyObjectResult struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
ETag *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
LastModified *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CopyObjectResult) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CopyObjectResult) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetETag sets the ETag field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectResult) SetETag(v string) *CopyObjectResult {
|
|
s.ETag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastModified sets the LastModified field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyObjectResult) SetLastModified(v time.Time) *CopyObjectResult {
|
|
s.LastModified = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CopyPartResult struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Entity tag of the object.
|
|
ETag *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Date and time at which the object was uploaded.
|
|
LastModified *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CopyPartResult) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CopyPartResult) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetETag sets the ETag field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyPartResult) SetETag(v string) *CopyPartResult {
|
|
s.ETag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastModified sets the LastModified field's value.
|
|
func (s *CopyPartResult) SetLastModified(v time.Time) *CopyPartResult {
|
|
s.LastModified = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateBucketConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the region where the bucket will be created. If you don't specify
|
|
// a region, the bucket is created in US East (N. Virginia) Region (us-east-1).
|
|
LocationConstraint *string `type:"string" enum:"BucketLocationConstraint"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateBucketConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateBucketConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLocationConstraint sets the LocationConstraint field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateBucketConfiguration) SetLocationConstraint(v string) *CreateBucketConfiguration {
|
|
s.LocationConstraint = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateBucketInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"CreateBucketConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// The canned ACL to apply to the bucket.
|
|
ACL *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-acl" type:"string" enum:"BucketCannedACL"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
CreateBucketConfiguration *CreateBucketConfiguration `locationName:"CreateBucketConfiguration" type:"structure" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee the read, write, read ACP, and write ACP permissions on the
|
|
// bucket.
|
|
GrantFullControl *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-full-control" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to list the objects in the bucket.
|
|
GrantRead *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-read" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to read the bucket ACL.
|
|
GrantReadACP *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-read-acp" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to create, overwrite, and delete any object in the bucket.
|
|
GrantWrite *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-write" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to write the ACL for the applicable bucket.
|
|
GrantWriteACP *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-write-acp" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether you want S3 Object Lock to be enabled for the new bucket.
|
|
ObjectLockEnabledForBucket *bool `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-bucket-object-lock-enabled" type:"boolean"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateBucketInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateBucketInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateBucketInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateBucketInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetACL sets the ACL field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateBucketInput) SetACL(v string) *CreateBucketInput {
|
|
s.ACL = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateBucketInput) SetBucket(v string) *CreateBucketInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *CreateBucketInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreateBucketConfiguration sets the CreateBucketConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateBucketInput) SetCreateBucketConfiguration(v *CreateBucketConfiguration) *CreateBucketInput {
|
|
s.CreateBucketConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantFullControl sets the GrantFullControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateBucketInput) SetGrantFullControl(v string) *CreateBucketInput {
|
|
s.GrantFullControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantRead sets the GrantRead field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateBucketInput) SetGrantRead(v string) *CreateBucketInput {
|
|
s.GrantRead = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantReadACP sets the GrantReadACP field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateBucketInput) SetGrantReadACP(v string) *CreateBucketInput {
|
|
s.GrantReadACP = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantWrite sets the GrantWrite field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateBucketInput) SetGrantWrite(v string) *CreateBucketInput {
|
|
s.GrantWrite = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantWriteACP sets the GrantWriteACP field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateBucketInput) SetGrantWriteACP(v string) *CreateBucketInput {
|
|
s.GrantWriteACP = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockEnabledForBucket sets the ObjectLockEnabledForBucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateBucketInput) SetObjectLockEnabledForBucket(v bool) *CreateBucketInput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockEnabledForBucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateBucketOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Location *string `location:"header" locationName:"Location" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateBucketOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateBucketOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLocation sets the Location field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateBucketOutput) SetLocation(v string) *CreateBucketOutput {
|
|
s.Location = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateMultipartUploadInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The canned ACL to apply to the object.
|
|
ACL *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-acl" type:"string" enum:"ObjectCannedACL"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies caching behavior along the request/reply chain.
|
|
CacheControl *string `location:"header" locationName:"Cache-Control" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies presentational information for the object.
|
|
ContentDisposition *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Disposition" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies what content encodings have been applied to the object and thus
|
|
// what decoding mechanisms must be applied to obtain the media-type referenced
|
|
// by the Content-Type header field.
|
|
ContentEncoding *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Encoding" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The language the content is in.
|
|
ContentLanguage *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Language" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A standard MIME type describing the format of the object data.
|
|
ContentType *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Type" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The date and time at which the object is no longer cacheable.
|
|
Expires *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"Expires" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Gives the grantee READ, READ_ACP, and WRITE_ACP permissions on the object.
|
|
GrantFullControl *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-full-control" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to read the object data and its metadata.
|
|
GrantRead *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-read" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to read the object ACL.
|
|
GrantReadACP *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-read-acp" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to write the ACL for the applicable object.
|
|
GrantWriteACP *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-write-acp" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A map of metadata to store with the object in S3.
|
|
Metadata map[string]*string `location:"headers" locationName:"x-amz-meta-" type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether you want to apply a Legal Hold to the uploaded object.
|
|
ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-legal-hold" type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the Object Lock mode that you want to apply to the uploaded object.
|
|
ObjectLockMode *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-mode" type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the date and time when you want the Object Lock to expire.
|
|
ObjectLockRetainUntilDate *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-retain-until-date" type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the algorithm to use to when encrypting the object (e.g., AES256).
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting
|
|
// data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded; Amazon
|
|
// does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with
|
|
// the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm
|
|
// header.
|
|
SSECustomerKey *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321.
|
|
// Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure the encryption
|
|
// key was transmitted without error.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the AWS KMS key ID to use for object encryption. All GET and PUT
|
|
// requests for an object protected by AWS KMS will fail if not made via SSL
|
|
// or using SigV4. Documentation on configuring any of the officially supported
|
|
// AWS SDKs and CLI can be found at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/UsingAWSSDK.html#specify-signature-version
|
|
SSEKMSKeyId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The Server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
|
|
// (e.g., AES256, aws:kms).
|
|
ServerSideEncryption *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption" type:"string" enum:"ServerSideEncryption"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of storage to use for the object. Defaults to 'STANDARD'.
|
|
StorageClass *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-storage-class" type:"string" enum:"StorageClass"`
|
|
|
|
// The tag-set for the object. The tag-set must be encoded as URL Query parameters
|
|
Tagging *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-tagging" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the bucket is configured as a website, redirects requests for this object
|
|
// to another object in the same bucket or to an external URL. Amazon S3 stores
|
|
// the value of this header in the object metadata.
|
|
WebsiteRedirectLocation *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-website-redirect-location" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateMultipartUploadInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateMultipartUploadInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateMultipartUploadInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetACL sets the ACL field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetACL(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.ACL = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetBucket(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCacheControl sets the CacheControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetCacheControl(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.CacheControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentDisposition sets the ContentDisposition field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetContentDisposition(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.ContentDisposition = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentEncoding sets the ContentEncoding field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetContentEncoding(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.ContentEncoding = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentLanguage sets the ContentLanguage field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetContentLanguage(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.ContentLanguage = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentType sets the ContentType field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetContentType(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.ContentType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpires sets the Expires field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetExpires(v time.Time) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.Expires = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantFullControl sets the GrantFullControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetGrantFullControl(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.GrantFullControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantRead sets the GrantRead field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetGrantRead(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.GrantRead = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantReadACP sets the GrantReadACP field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetGrantReadACP(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.GrantReadACP = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantWriteACP sets the GrantWriteACP field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetGrantWriteACP(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.GrantWriteACP = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetKey(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMetadata sets the Metadata field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetMetadata(v map[string]*string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.Metadata = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockLegalHoldStatus sets the ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetObjectLockLegalHoldStatus(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockMode sets the ObjectLockMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetObjectLockMode(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockRetainUntilDate sets the ObjectLockRetainUntilDate field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetObjectLockRetainUntilDate(v time.Time) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockRetainUntilDate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKey sets the SSECustomerKey field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetSSECustomerKey(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKey = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) getSSECustomerKey() (v string) {
|
|
if s.SSECustomerKey == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.SSECustomerKey
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSEKMSKeyId sets the SSEKMSKeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetSSEKMSKeyId(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.SSEKMSKeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerSideEncryption sets the ServerSideEncryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetServerSideEncryption(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.ServerSideEncryption = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClass sets the StorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetStorageClass(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.StorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTagging sets the Tagging field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetTagging(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.Tagging = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWebsiteRedirectLocation sets the WebsiteRedirectLocation field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadInput) SetWebsiteRedirectLocation(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadInput {
|
|
s.WebsiteRedirectLocation = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateMultipartUploadOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Date when multipart upload will become eligible for abort operation by lifecycle.
|
|
AbortDate *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-abort-date" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Id of the lifecycle rule that makes a multipart upload eligible for abort
|
|
// operation.
|
|
AbortRuleId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-abort-rule-id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the bucket to which the multipart upload was initiated.
|
|
Bucket *string `locationName:"Bucket" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Object key for which the multipart upload was initiated.
|
|
Key *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header confirming the encryption algorithm
|
|
// used.
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header to provide round trip message integrity
|
|
// verification of the customer-provided encryption key.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, specifies the ID of the AWS Key Management Service (KMS) master
|
|
// encryption key that was used for the object.
|
|
SSEKMSKeyId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The Server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
|
|
// (e.g., AES256, aws:kms).
|
|
ServerSideEncryption *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption" type:"string" enum:"ServerSideEncryption"`
|
|
|
|
// ID for the initiated multipart upload.
|
|
UploadId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateMultipartUploadOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateMultipartUploadOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAbortDate sets the AbortDate field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadOutput) SetAbortDate(v time.Time) *CreateMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.AbortDate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAbortRuleId sets the AbortRuleId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadOutput) SetAbortRuleId(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.AbortRuleId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadOutput) SetBucket(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadOutput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadOutput) SetKey(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadOutput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadOutput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSEKMSKeyId sets the SSEKMSKeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadOutput) SetSSEKMSKeyId(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.SSEKMSKeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerSideEncryption sets the ServerSideEncryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadOutput) SetServerSideEncryption(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.ServerSideEncryption = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUploadId sets the UploadId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateMultipartUploadOutput) SetUploadId(v string) *CreateMultipartUploadOutput {
|
|
s.UploadId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The container element for specifying the default Object Lock retention settings
|
|
// for new objects placed in the specified bucket.
|
|
type DefaultRetention struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of days that you want to specify for the default retention period.
|
|
Days *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The default Object Lock retention mode you want to apply to new objects placed
|
|
// in the specified bucket.
|
|
Mode *string `type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockRetentionMode"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of years that you want to specify for the default retention period.
|
|
Years *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DefaultRetention) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DefaultRetention) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDays sets the Days field's value.
|
|
func (s *DefaultRetention) SetDays(v int64) *DefaultRetention {
|
|
s.Days = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMode sets the Mode field's value.
|
|
func (s *DefaultRetention) SetMode(v string) *DefaultRetention {
|
|
s.Mode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetYears sets the Years field's value.
|
|
func (s *DefaultRetention) SetYears(v int64) *DefaultRetention {
|
|
s.Years = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Delete struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Objects is a required field
|
|
Objects []*ObjectIdentifier `locationName:"Object" type:"list" flattened:"true" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Element to enable quiet mode for the request. When you add this element,
|
|
// you must set its value to true.
|
|
Quiet *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Delete) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Delete) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Delete) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Delete"}
|
|
if s.Objects == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Objects"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Objects != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Objects {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Objects", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjects sets the Objects field's value.
|
|
func (s *Delete) SetObjects(v []*ObjectIdentifier) *Delete {
|
|
s.Objects = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetQuiet sets the Quiet field's value.
|
|
func (s *Delete) SetQuiet(v bool) *Delete {
|
|
s.Quiet = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket from which an analytics configuration is deleted.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The identifier used to represent an analytics configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Id is a required field
|
|
Id *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"id" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Id == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) SetId(v string) *DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketCorsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketCorsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketCorsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketCorsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteBucketCorsInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketCorsInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteBucketCorsInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketCorsInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketCorsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketCorsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketCorsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketEncryptionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket containing the server-side encryption configuration
|
|
// to delete.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketEncryptionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketEncryptionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketEncryptionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteBucketEncryptionInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketEncryptionInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteBucketEncryptionInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketEncryptionInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketEncryptionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketEncryptionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketEncryptionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteBucketInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteBucketInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket containing the inventory configuration to delete.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID used to identify the inventory configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Id is a required field
|
|
Id *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"id" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Id == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) SetId(v string) *DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketLifecycleInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketLifecycleInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketLifecycleInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketLifecycleInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteBucketLifecycleInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketLifecycleInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteBucketLifecycleInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketLifecycleInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketLifecycleOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketLifecycleOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketLifecycleOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket containing the metrics configuration to delete.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID used to identify the metrics configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Id is a required field
|
|
Id *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"id" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Id == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) SetId(v string) *DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketPolicyInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketPolicyInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketPolicyInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketPolicyInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteBucketPolicyInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketPolicyInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteBucketPolicyInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketPolicyInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketPolicyOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketPolicyOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketPolicyOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketReplicationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The bucket name.
|
|
//
|
|
// It can take a while to propagate the deletion of a replication configuration
|
|
// to all Amazon S3 systems.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketReplicationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketReplicationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketReplicationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteBucketReplicationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketReplicationInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteBucketReplicationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketReplicationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketReplicationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketReplicationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketReplicationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketTaggingInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketTaggingInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketTaggingInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketTaggingInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteBucketTaggingInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketTaggingInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteBucketTaggingInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketTaggingInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketTaggingOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketTaggingOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketTaggingOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketWebsiteInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketWebsiteInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketWebsiteInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketWebsiteInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteBucketWebsiteInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketWebsiteInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteBucketWebsiteInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteBucketWebsiteInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteBucketWebsiteOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketWebsiteOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteBucketWebsiteOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteMarkerEntry struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether the object is (true) or is not (false) the latest version
|
|
// of an object.
|
|
IsLatest *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The object key.
|
|
Key *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Date and time the object was last modified.
|
|
LastModified *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
Owner *Owner `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Version ID of an object.
|
|
VersionId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteMarkerEntry) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteMarkerEntry) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIsLatest sets the IsLatest field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteMarkerEntry) SetIsLatest(v bool) *DeleteMarkerEntry {
|
|
s.IsLatest = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteMarkerEntry) SetKey(v string) *DeleteMarkerEntry {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastModified sets the LastModified field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteMarkerEntry) SetLastModified(v time.Time) *DeleteMarkerEntry {
|
|
s.LastModified = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwner sets the Owner field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteMarkerEntry) SetOwner(v *Owner) *DeleteMarkerEntry {
|
|
s.Owner = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteMarkerEntry) SetVersionId(v string) *DeleteMarkerEntry {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether Amazon S3 should replicate delete makers.
|
|
type DeleteMarkerReplication struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The status of the delete marker replication.
|
|
//
|
|
// In the current implementation, Amazon S3 doesn't replicate the delete markers.
|
|
// The status must be Disabled.
|
|
Status *string `type:"string" enum:"DeleteMarkerReplicationStatus"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteMarkerReplication) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteMarkerReplication) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteMarkerReplication) SetStatus(v string) *DeleteMarkerReplication {
|
|
s.Status = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteObjectInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether S3 Object Lock should bypass Governance-mode restrictions
|
|
// to process this operation.
|
|
BypassGovernanceRetention *bool `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-bypass-governance-retention" type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The concatenation of the authentication device's serial number, a space,
|
|
// and the value that is displayed on your authentication device.
|
|
MFA *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-mfa" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// VersionId used to reference a specific version of the object.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"versionId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteObjectInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteObjectInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteObjectInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteObjectInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBypassGovernanceRetention sets the BypassGovernanceRetention field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectInput) SetBypassGovernanceRetention(v bool) *DeleteObjectInput {
|
|
s.BypassGovernanceRetention = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectInput) SetKey(v string) *DeleteObjectInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMFA sets the MFA field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectInput) SetMFA(v string) *DeleteObjectInput {
|
|
s.MFA = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *DeleteObjectInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectInput) SetVersionId(v string) *DeleteObjectInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteObjectOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether the versioned object that was permanently deleted was (true)
|
|
// or was not (false) a delete marker.
|
|
DeleteMarker *bool `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-delete-marker" type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
|
|
// Returns the version ID of the delete marker created as a result of the DELETE
|
|
// operation.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-version-id" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteObjectOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteObjectOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeleteMarker sets the DeleteMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectOutput) SetDeleteMarker(v bool) *DeleteObjectOutput {
|
|
s.DeleteMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *DeleteObjectOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectOutput) SetVersionId(v string) *DeleteObjectOutput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteObjectTaggingInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The versionId of the object that the tag-set will be removed from.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"versionId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteObjectTaggingInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteObjectTaggingInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectTaggingInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteObjectTaggingInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectTaggingInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteObjectTaggingInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectTaggingInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectTaggingInput) SetKey(v string) *DeleteObjectTaggingInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectTaggingInput) SetVersionId(v string) *DeleteObjectTaggingInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteObjectTaggingOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The versionId of the object the tag-set was removed from.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-version-id" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteObjectTaggingOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteObjectTaggingOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectTaggingOutput) SetVersionId(v string) *DeleteObjectTaggingOutput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteObjectsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"Delete"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether you want to delete this object even if it has a Governance-type
|
|
// Object Lock in place. You must have sufficient permissions to perform this
|
|
// operation.
|
|
BypassGovernanceRetention *bool `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-bypass-governance-retention" type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// Delete is a required field
|
|
Delete *Delete `locationName:"Delete" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
|
|
// The concatenation of the authentication device's serial number, a space,
|
|
// and the value that is displayed on your authentication device.
|
|
MFA *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-mfa" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteObjectsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteObjectsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteObjectsInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Delete == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Delete"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Delete != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Delete.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Delete", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectsInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeleteObjectsInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectsInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBypassGovernanceRetention sets the BypassGovernanceRetention field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectsInput) SetBypassGovernanceRetention(v bool) *DeleteObjectsInput {
|
|
s.BypassGovernanceRetention = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDelete sets the Delete field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectsInput) SetDelete(v *Delete) *DeleteObjectsInput {
|
|
s.Delete = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMFA sets the MFA field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectsInput) SetMFA(v string) *DeleteObjectsInput {
|
|
s.MFA = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectsInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *DeleteObjectsInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteObjectsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Deleted []*DeletedObject `type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
Errors []*Error `locationName:"Error" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteObjectsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteObjectsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeleted sets the Deleted field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectsOutput) SetDeleted(v []*DeletedObject) *DeleteObjectsOutput {
|
|
s.Deleted = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrors sets the Errors field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectsOutput) SetErrors(v []*Error) *DeleteObjectsOutput {
|
|
s.Errors = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteObjectsOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *DeleteObjectsOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeletePublicAccessBlockInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The Amazon S3 bucket whose PublicAccessBlock configuration you want to delete.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeletePublicAccessBlockInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeletePublicAccessBlockInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeletePublicAccessBlockInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeletePublicAccessBlockInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeletePublicAccessBlockInput) SetBucket(v string) *DeletePublicAccessBlockInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *DeletePublicAccessBlockInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeletePublicAccessBlockOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeletePublicAccessBlockOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeletePublicAccessBlockOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeletedObject struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
DeleteMarker *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
DeleteMarkerVersionId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Key *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
VersionId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeletedObject) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeletedObject) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeleteMarker sets the DeleteMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeletedObject) SetDeleteMarker(v bool) *DeletedObject {
|
|
s.DeleteMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeleteMarkerVersionId sets the DeleteMarkerVersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeletedObject) SetDeleteMarkerVersionId(v string) *DeletedObject {
|
|
s.DeleteMarkerVersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeletedObject) SetKey(v string) *DeletedObject {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeletedObject) SetVersionId(v string) *DeletedObject {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for information about the replication destination.
|
|
type Destination struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for information about access control for replicas.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use this element only in a cross-account scenario where source and destination
|
|
// bucket owners are not the same to change replica ownership to the AWS account
|
|
// that owns the destination bucket. If you don't add this element to the replication
|
|
// configuration, the replicas are owned by same AWS account that owns the source
|
|
// object.
|
|
AccessControlTranslation *AccessControlTranslation `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The account ID of the destination bucket. Currently, Amazon S3 verifies this
|
|
// value only if Access Control Translation is enabled.
|
|
//
|
|
// In a cross-account scenario, if you change replica ownership to the AWS account
|
|
// that owns the destination bucket by adding the AccessControlTranslation element,
|
|
// this is the account ID of the owner of the destination bucket.
|
|
Account *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the bucket where you want Amazon S3 to
|
|
// store replicas of the object identified by the rule.
|
|
//
|
|
// If there are multiple rules in your replication configuration, all rules
|
|
// must specify the same bucket as the destination. A replication configuration
|
|
// can replicate objects to only one destination bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A container that provides information about encryption. If SourceSelectionCriteria
|
|
// is specified, you must specify this element.
|
|
EncryptionConfiguration *EncryptionConfiguration `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The class of storage used to store the object. By default Amazon S3 uses
|
|
// storage class of the source object when creating a replica.
|
|
StorageClass *string `type:"string" enum:"StorageClass"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Destination) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Destination) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Destination) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Destination"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.AccessControlTranslation != nil {
|
|
if err := s.AccessControlTranslation.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("AccessControlTranslation", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAccessControlTranslation sets the AccessControlTranslation field's value.
|
|
func (s *Destination) SetAccessControlTranslation(v *AccessControlTranslation) *Destination {
|
|
s.AccessControlTranslation = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAccount sets the Account field's value.
|
|
func (s *Destination) SetAccount(v string) *Destination {
|
|
s.Account = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *Destination) SetBucket(v string) *Destination {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *Destination) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncryptionConfiguration sets the EncryptionConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *Destination) SetEncryptionConfiguration(v *EncryptionConfiguration) *Destination {
|
|
s.EncryptionConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClass sets the StorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *Destination) SetStorageClass(v string) *Destination {
|
|
s.StorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Describes the server-side encryption that will be applied to the restore
|
|
// results.
|
|
type Encryption struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing job results in Amazon
|
|
// S3 (e.g., AES256, aws:kms).
|
|
//
|
|
// EncryptionType is a required field
|
|
EncryptionType *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"ServerSideEncryption"`
|
|
|
|
// If the encryption type is aws:kms, this optional value can be used to specify
|
|
// the encryption context for the restore results.
|
|
KMSContext *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the encryption type is aws:kms, this optional value specifies the AWS
|
|
// KMS key ID to use for encryption of job results.
|
|
KMSKeyId *string `type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Encryption) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Encryption) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Encryption) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Encryption"}
|
|
if s.EncryptionType == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("EncryptionType"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncryptionType sets the EncryptionType field's value.
|
|
func (s *Encryption) SetEncryptionType(v string) *Encryption {
|
|
s.EncryptionType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKMSContext sets the KMSContext field's value.
|
|
func (s *Encryption) SetKMSContext(v string) *Encryption {
|
|
s.KMSContext = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKMSKeyId sets the KMSKeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *Encryption) SetKMSKeyId(v string) *Encryption {
|
|
s.KMSKeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for information about the encryption-based configuration for
|
|
// replicas.
|
|
type EncryptionConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the AWS KMS key for the AWS Region where the destination bucket
|
|
// resides. Amazon S3 uses this key to encrypt the replica object.
|
|
ReplicaKmsKeyID *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EncryptionConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EncryptionConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReplicaKmsKeyID sets the ReplicaKmsKeyID field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncryptionConfiguration) SetReplicaKmsKeyID(v string) *EncryptionConfiguration {
|
|
s.ReplicaKmsKeyID = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type EndEvent struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `locationName:"EndEvent" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EndEvent) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EndEvent) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The EndEvent is and event in the SelectObjectContentEventStream group of events.
|
|
func (s *EndEvent) eventSelectObjectContentEventStream() {}
|
|
|
|
// UnmarshalEvent unmarshals the EventStream Message into the EndEvent value.
|
|
// This method is only used internally within the SDK's EventStream handling.
|
|
func (s *EndEvent) UnmarshalEvent(
|
|
payloadUnmarshaler protocol.PayloadUnmarshaler,
|
|
msg eventstream.Message,
|
|
) error {
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Error struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Code *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Key *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Message *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
VersionId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Error) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Error) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCode sets the Code field's value.
|
|
func (s *Error) SetCode(v string) *Error {
|
|
s.Code = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *Error) SetKey(v string) *Error {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMessage sets the Message field's value.
|
|
func (s *Error) SetMessage(v string) *Error {
|
|
s.Message = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *Error) SetVersionId(v string) *Error {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ErrorDocument struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The object key name to use when a 4XX class error occurs.
|
|
//
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ErrorDocument) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ErrorDocument) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ErrorDocument) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ErrorDocument"}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *ErrorDocument) SetKey(v string) *ErrorDocument {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for a key value pair that defines the criteria for the filter
|
|
// rule.
|
|
type FilterRule struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The object key name prefix or suffix identifying one or more objects to which
|
|
// the filtering rule applies. The maximum prefix length is 1,024 characters.
|
|
// Overlapping prefixes and suffixes are not supported. For more information,
|
|
// see Configuring Event Notifications (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/NotificationHowTo.html)
|
|
// in the Amazon Simple Storage Service Developer Guide.
|
|
Name *string `type:"string" enum:"FilterRuleName"`
|
|
|
|
Value *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s FilterRule) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s FilterRule) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *FilterRule) SetName(v string) *FilterRule {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetValue sets the Value field's value.
|
|
func (s *FilterRule) SetValue(v string) *FilterRule {
|
|
s.Value = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the bucket for which the accelerate configuration is retrieved.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The accelerate configuration of the bucket.
|
|
Status *string `type:"string" enum:"BucketAccelerateStatus"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput) SetStatus(v string) *GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput {
|
|
s.Status = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketAclInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketAclInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketAclInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAclInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketAclInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAclInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketAclInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAclInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketAclOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of grants.
|
|
Grants []*Grant `locationName:"AccessControlList" locationNameList:"Grant" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
Owner *Owner `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketAclOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketAclOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrants sets the Grants field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAclOutput) SetGrants(v []*Grant) *GetBucketAclOutput {
|
|
s.Grants = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwner sets the Owner field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAclOutput) SetOwner(v *Owner) *GetBucketAclOutput {
|
|
s.Owner = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket from which an analytics configuration is retrieved.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The identifier used to represent an analytics configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Id is a required field
|
|
Id *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"id" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Id == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) SetId(v string) *GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"AnalyticsConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// The configuration and any analyses for the analytics filter.
|
|
AnalyticsConfiguration *AnalyticsConfiguration `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAnalyticsConfiguration sets the AnalyticsConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput) SetAnalyticsConfiguration(v *AnalyticsConfiguration) *GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput {
|
|
s.AnalyticsConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketCorsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketCorsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketCorsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketCorsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketCorsInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketCorsInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketCorsInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketCorsInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketCorsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
CORSRules []*CORSRule `locationName:"CORSRule" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketCorsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketCorsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCORSRules sets the CORSRules field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketCorsOutput) SetCORSRules(v []*CORSRule) *GetBucketCorsOutput {
|
|
s.CORSRules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketEncryptionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket from which the server-side encryption configuration
|
|
// is retrieved.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketEncryptionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketEncryptionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketEncryptionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketEncryptionInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketEncryptionInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketEncryptionInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketEncryptionInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketEncryptionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// Container for server-side encryption configuration rules. Currently S3 supports
|
|
// one rule only.
|
|
ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration *ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketEncryptionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketEncryptionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerSideEncryptionConfiguration sets the ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketEncryptionOutput) SetServerSideEncryptionConfiguration(v *ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration) *GetBucketEncryptionOutput {
|
|
s.ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket containing the inventory configuration to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID used to identify the inventory configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Id is a required field
|
|
Id *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"id" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Id == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) SetId(v string) *GetBucketInventoryConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"InventoryConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the inventory configuration.
|
|
InventoryConfiguration *InventoryConfiguration `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInventoryConfiguration sets the InventoryConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput) SetInventoryConfiguration(v *InventoryConfiguration) *GetBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput {
|
|
s.InventoryConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Rules []*LifecycleRule `locationName:"Rule" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRules sets the Rules field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput) SetRules(v []*LifecycleRule) *GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput {
|
|
s.Rules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketLifecycleInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLifecycleInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLifecycleInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLifecycleInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketLifecycleInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLifecycleInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketLifecycleInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLifecycleInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketLifecycleOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Rules []*Rule `locationName:"Rule" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLifecycleOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLifecycleOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRules sets the Rules field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLifecycleOutput) SetRules(v []*Rule) *GetBucketLifecycleOutput {
|
|
s.Rules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketLocationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLocationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLocationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLocationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketLocationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLocationInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketLocationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLocationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketLocationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
LocationConstraint *string `type:"string" enum:"BucketLocationConstraint"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLocationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLocationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLocationConstraint sets the LocationConstraint field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLocationOutput) SetLocationConstraint(v string) *GetBucketLocationOutput {
|
|
s.LocationConstraint = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketLoggingInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLoggingInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLoggingInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLoggingInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketLoggingInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLoggingInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketLoggingInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLoggingInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketLoggingOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Container for logging information. Presence of this element indicates that
|
|
// logging is enabled. Parameters TargetBucket and TargetPrefix are required
|
|
// in this case.
|
|
LoggingEnabled *LoggingEnabled `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLoggingOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketLoggingOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLoggingEnabled sets the LoggingEnabled field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketLoggingOutput) SetLoggingEnabled(v *LoggingEnabled) *GetBucketLoggingOutput {
|
|
s.LoggingEnabled = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket containing the metrics configuration to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID used to identify the metrics configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Id is a required field
|
|
Id *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"id" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Id == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) SetId(v string) *GetBucketMetricsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"MetricsConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the metrics configuration.
|
|
MetricsConfiguration *MetricsConfiguration `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMetricsConfiguration sets the MetricsConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput) SetMetricsConfiguration(v *MetricsConfiguration) *GetBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput {
|
|
s.MetricsConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the bucket to get the notification configuration for.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketPolicyInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketPolicyInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketPolicyInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketPolicyInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketPolicyInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketPolicyInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketPolicyInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketPolicyInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketPolicyOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"Policy"`
|
|
|
|
// The bucket policy as a JSON document.
|
|
Policy *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketPolicyOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketPolicyOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPolicy sets the Policy field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketPolicyOutput) SetPolicy(v string) *GetBucketPolicyOutput {
|
|
s.Policy = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketPolicyStatusInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the Amazon S3 bucket whose policy status you want to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketPolicyStatusInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketPolicyStatusInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketPolicyStatusInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketPolicyStatusInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketPolicyStatusInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketPolicyStatusInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketPolicyStatusInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketPolicyStatusOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"PolicyStatus"`
|
|
|
|
// The policy status for the specified bucket.
|
|
PolicyStatus *PolicyStatus `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketPolicyStatusOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketPolicyStatusOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPolicyStatus sets the PolicyStatus field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketPolicyStatusOutput) SetPolicyStatus(v *PolicyStatus) *GetBucketPolicyStatusOutput {
|
|
s.PolicyStatus = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketReplicationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketReplicationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketReplicationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketReplicationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketReplicationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketReplicationInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketReplicationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketReplicationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketReplicationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"ReplicationConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for replication rules. You can add up to 1,000 rules. The maximum
|
|
// size of a replication configuration is 2 MB.
|
|
ReplicationConfiguration *ReplicationConfiguration `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketReplicationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketReplicationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReplicationConfiguration sets the ReplicationConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketReplicationOutput) SetReplicationConfiguration(v *ReplicationConfiguration) *GetBucketReplicationOutput {
|
|
s.ReplicationConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketRequestPaymentInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketRequestPaymentInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketRequestPaymentInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketRequestPaymentInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketRequestPaymentInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketRequestPaymentInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketRequestPaymentInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketRequestPaymentInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketRequestPaymentOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies who pays for the download and request fees.
|
|
Payer *string `type:"string" enum:"Payer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketRequestPaymentOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketRequestPaymentOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPayer sets the Payer field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketRequestPaymentOutput) SetPayer(v string) *GetBucketRequestPaymentOutput {
|
|
s.Payer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketTaggingInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketTaggingInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketTaggingInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketTaggingInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketTaggingInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketTaggingInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketTaggingInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketTaggingInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketTaggingOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// TagSet is a required field
|
|
TagSet []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketTaggingOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketTaggingOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTagSet sets the TagSet field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketTaggingOutput) SetTagSet(v []*Tag) *GetBucketTaggingOutput {
|
|
s.TagSet = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketVersioningInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketVersioningInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketVersioningInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketVersioningInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketVersioningInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketVersioningInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketVersioningInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketVersioningInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketVersioningOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether MFA delete is enabled in the bucket versioning configuration.
|
|
// This element is only returned if the bucket has been configured with MFA
|
|
// delete. If the bucket has never been so configured, this element is not returned.
|
|
MFADelete *string `locationName:"MfaDelete" type:"string" enum:"MFADeleteStatus"`
|
|
|
|
// The versioning state of the bucket.
|
|
Status *string `type:"string" enum:"BucketVersioningStatus"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketVersioningOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketVersioningOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMFADelete sets the MFADelete field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketVersioningOutput) SetMFADelete(v string) *GetBucketVersioningOutput {
|
|
s.MFADelete = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketVersioningOutput) SetStatus(v string) *GetBucketVersioningOutput {
|
|
s.Status = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketWebsiteInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketWebsiteInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketWebsiteInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketWebsiteInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetBucketWebsiteInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketWebsiteInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetBucketWebsiteInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetBucketWebsiteInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetBucketWebsiteOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
ErrorDocument *ErrorDocument `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
IndexDocument *IndexDocument `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
RedirectAllRequestsTo *RedirectAllRequestsTo `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
RoutingRules []*RoutingRule `locationNameList:"RoutingRule" type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketWebsiteOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetBucketWebsiteOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrorDocument sets the ErrorDocument field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketWebsiteOutput) SetErrorDocument(v *ErrorDocument) *GetBucketWebsiteOutput {
|
|
s.ErrorDocument = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIndexDocument sets the IndexDocument field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketWebsiteOutput) SetIndexDocument(v *IndexDocument) *GetBucketWebsiteOutput {
|
|
s.IndexDocument = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRedirectAllRequestsTo sets the RedirectAllRequestsTo field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketWebsiteOutput) SetRedirectAllRequestsTo(v *RedirectAllRequestsTo) *GetBucketWebsiteOutput {
|
|
s.RedirectAllRequestsTo = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoutingRules sets the RoutingRules field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetBucketWebsiteOutput) SetRoutingRules(v []*RoutingRule) *GetBucketWebsiteOutput {
|
|
s.RoutingRules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectAclInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// VersionId used to reference a specific version of the object.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"versionId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectAclInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectAclInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectAclInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetObjectAclInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectAclInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetObjectAclInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectAclInput) SetKey(v string) *GetObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectAclInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *GetObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectAclInput) SetVersionId(v string) *GetObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectAclOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of grants.
|
|
Grants []*Grant `locationName:"AccessControlList" locationNameList:"Grant" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
Owner *Owner `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectAclOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectAclOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrants sets the Grants field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectAclOutput) SetGrants(v []*Grant) *GetObjectAclOutput {
|
|
s.Grants = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwner sets the Owner field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectAclOutput) SetOwner(v *Owner) *GetObjectAclOutput {
|
|
s.Owner = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectAclOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *GetObjectAclOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Return the object only if its entity tag (ETag) is the same as the one specified,
|
|
// otherwise return a 412 (precondition failed).
|
|
IfMatch *string `location:"header" locationName:"If-Match" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Return the object only if it has been modified since the specified time,
|
|
// otherwise return a 304 (not modified).
|
|
IfModifiedSince *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"If-Modified-Since" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Return the object only if its entity tag (ETag) is different from the one
|
|
// specified, otherwise return a 304 (not modified).
|
|
IfNoneMatch *string `location:"header" locationName:"If-None-Match" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Return the object only if it has not been modified since the specified time,
|
|
// otherwise return a 412 (precondition failed).
|
|
IfUnmodifiedSince *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"If-Unmodified-Since" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Part number of the object being read. This is a positive integer between
|
|
// 1 and 10,000. Effectively performs a 'ranged' GET request for the part specified.
|
|
// Useful for downloading just a part of an object.
|
|
PartNumber *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"partNumber" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Downloads the specified range bytes of an object. For more information about
|
|
// the HTTP Range header, go to http://www.w3.org/Protocols/rfc2616/rfc2616-sec14.html#sec14.35.
|
|
Range *string `location:"header" locationName:"Range" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the Cache-Control header of the response.
|
|
ResponseCacheControl *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"response-cache-control" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the Content-Disposition header of the response
|
|
ResponseContentDisposition *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"response-content-disposition" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the Content-Encoding header of the response.
|
|
ResponseContentEncoding *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"response-content-encoding" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the Content-Language header of the response.
|
|
ResponseContentLanguage *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"response-content-language" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the Content-Type header of the response.
|
|
ResponseContentType *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"response-content-type" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the Expires header of the response.
|
|
ResponseExpires *time.Time `location:"querystring" locationName:"response-expires" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the algorithm to use to when encrypting the object (e.g., AES256).
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting
|
|
// data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded; Amazon
|
|
// does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with
|
|
// the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm
|
|
// header.
|
|
SSECustomerKey *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321.
|
|
// Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure the encryption
|
|
// key was transmitted without error.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// VersionId used to reference a specific version of the object.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"versionId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetObjectInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIfMatch sets the IfMatch field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetIfMatch(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.IfMatch = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIfModifiedSince sets the IfModifiedSince field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetIfModifiedSince(v time.Time) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.IfModifiedSince = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIfNoneMatch sets the IfNoneMatch field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetIfNoneMatch(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.IfNoneMatch = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIfUnmodifiedSince sets the IfUnmodifiedSince field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetIfUnmodifiedSince(v time.Time) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.IfUnmodifiedSince = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetKey(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartNumber sets the PartNumber field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetPartNumber(v int64) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.PartNumber = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRange sets the Range field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetRange(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.Range = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResponseCacheControl sets the ResponseCacheControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetResponseCacheControl(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.ResponseCacheControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResponseContentDisposition sets the ResponseContentDisposition field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetResponseContentDisposition(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.ResponseContentDisposition = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResponseContentEncoding sets the ResponseContentEncoding field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetResponseContentEncoding(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.ResponseContentEncoding = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResponseContentLanguage sets the ResponseContentLanguage field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetResponseContentLanguage(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.ResponseContentLanguage = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResponseContentType sets the ResponseContentType field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetResponseContentType(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.ResponseContentType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResponseExpires sets the ResponseExpires field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetResponseExpires(v time.Time) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.ResponseExpires = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKey sets the SSECustomerKey field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetSSECustomerKey(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKey = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) getSSECustomerKey() (v string) {
|
|
if s.SSECustomerKey == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.SSECustomerKey
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectInput) SetVersionId(v string) *GetObjectInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectLegalHoldInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The bucket containing the object whose Legal Hold status you want to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The key name for the object whose Legal Hold status you want to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// The version ID of the object whose Legal Hold status you want to retrieve.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"versionId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectLegalHoldInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectLegalHoldInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectLegalHoldInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetObjectLegalHoldInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectLegalHoldInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetObjectLegalHoldInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetObjectLegalHoldInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectLegalHoldInput) SetKey(v string) *GetObjectLegalHoldInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectLegalHoldInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *GetObjectLegalHoldInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectLegalHoldInput) SetVersionId(v string) *GetObjectLegalHoldInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectLegalHoldOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"LegalHold"`
|
|
|
|
// The current Legal Hold status for the specified object.
|
|
LegalHold *ObjectLockLegalHold `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectLegalHoldOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectLegalHoldOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLegalHold sets the LegalHold field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectLegalHoldOutput) SetLegalHold(v *ObjectLockLegalHold) *GetObjectLegalHoldOutput {
|
|
s.LegalHold = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectLockConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The bucket whose Object Lock configuration you want to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectLockConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectLockConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectLockConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetObjectLockConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectLockConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetObjectLockConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetObjectLockConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectLockConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"ObjectLockConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// The specified bucket's Object Lock configuration.
|
|
ObjectLockConfiguration *ObjectLockConfiguration `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectLockConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectLockConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockConfiguration sets the ObjectLockConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectLockConfigurationOutput) SetObjectLockConfiguration(v *ObjectLockConfiguration) *GetObjectLockConfigurationOutput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"Body"`
|
|
|
|
AcceptRanges *string `location:"header" locationName:"accept-ranges" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Object data.
|
|
Body io.ReadCloser `type:"blob"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies caching behavior along the request/reply chain.
|
|
CacheControl *string `location:"header" locationName:"Cache-Control" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies presentational information for the object.
|
|
ContentDisposition *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Disposition" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies what content encodings have been applied to the object and thus
|
|
// what decoding mechanisms must be applied to obtain the media-type referenced
|
|
// by the Content-Type header field.
|
|
ContentEncoding *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Encoding" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The language the content is in.
|
|
ContentLanguage *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Language" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Size of the body in bytes.
|
|
ContentLength *int64 `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Length" type:"long"`
|
|
|
|
// The portion of the object returned in the response.
|
|
ContentRange *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Range" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A standard MIME type describing the format of the object data.
|
|
ContentType *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Type" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether the object retrieved was (true) or was not (false) a Delete
|
|
// Marker. If false, this response header does not appear in the response.
|
|
DeleteMarker *bool `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-delete-marker" type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// An ETag is an opaque identifier assigned by a web server to a specific version
|
|
// of a resource found at a URL
|
|
ETag *string `location:"header" locationName:"ETag" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the object expiration is configured (see PUT Bucket lifecycle), the response
|
|
// includes this header. It includes the expiry-date and rule-id key value pairs
|
|
// providing object expiration information. The value of the rule-id is URL
|
|
// encoded.
|
|
Expiration *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-expiration" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The date and time at which the object is no longer cacheable.
|
|
Expires *string `location:"header" locationName:"Expires" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Last modified date of the object
|
|
LastModified *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"Last-Modified" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// A map of metadata to store with the object in S3.
|
|
Metadata map[string]*string `location:"headers" locationName:"x-amz-meta-" type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// This is set to the number of metadata entries not returned in x-amz-meta
|
|
// headers. This can happen if you create metadata using an API like SOAP that
|
|
// supports more flexible metadata than the REST API. For example, using SOAP,
|
|
// you can create metadata whose values are not legal HTTP headers.
|
|
MissingMeta *int64 `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-missing-meta" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether this object has an active legal hold. This field is only
|
|
// returned if you have permission to view an object's legal hold status.
|
|
ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-legal-hold" type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus"`
|
|
|
|
// The Object Lock mode currently in place for this object.
|
|
ObjectLockMode *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-mode" type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockMode"`
|
|
|
|
// The date and time when this object's Object Lock will expire.
|
|
ObjectLockRetainUntilDate *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-retain-until-date" type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
|
|
|
|
// The count of parts this object has.
|
|
PartsCount *int64 `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-mp-parts-count" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
ReplicationStatus *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-replication-status" type:"string" enum:"ReplicationStatus"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
|
|
// Provides information about object restoration operation and expiration time
|
|
// of the restored object copy.
|
|
Restore *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-restore" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header confirming the encryption algorithm
|
|
// used.
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header to provide round trip message integrity
|
|
// verification of the customer-provided encryption key.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, specifies the ID of the AWS Key Management Service (KMS) master
|
|
// encryption key that was used for the object.
|
|
SSEKMSKeyId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The Server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
|
|
// (e.g., AES256, aws:kms).
|
|
ServerSideEncryption *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption" type:"string" enum:"ServerSideEncryption"`
|
|
|
|
StorageClass *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-storage-class" type:"string" enum:"StorageClass"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of tags, if any, on the object.
|
|
TagCount *int64 `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-tagging-count" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Version of the object.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-version-id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the bucket is configured as a website, redirects requests for this object
|
|
// to another object in the same bucket or to an external URL. Amazon S3 stores
|
|
// the value of this header in the object metadata.
|
|
WebsiteRedirectLocation *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-website-redirect-location" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAcceptRanges sets the AcceptRanges field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetAcceptRanges(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.AcceptRanges = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBody sets the Body field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetBody(v io.ReadCloser) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.Body = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCacheControl sets the CacheControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetCacheControl(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.CacheControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentDisposition sets the ContentDisposition field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetContentDisposition(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ContentDisposition = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentEncoding sets the ContentEncoding field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetContentEncoding(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ContentEncoding = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentLanguage sets the ContentLanguage field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetContentLanguage(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ContentLanguage = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentLength sets the ContentLength field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetContentLength(v int64) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ContentLength = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentRange sets the ContentRange field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetContentRange(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ContentRange = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentType sets the ContentType field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetContentType(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ContentType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeleteMarker sets the DeleteMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetDeleteMarker(v bool) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.DeleteMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetETag sets the ETag field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetETag(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ETag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpiration sets the Expiration field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetExpiration(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.Expiration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpires sets the Expires field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetExpires(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.Expires = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastModified sets the LastModified field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetLastModified(v time.Time) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.LastModified = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMetadata sets the Metadata field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetMetadata(v map[string]*string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.Metadata = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMissingMeta sets the MissingMeta field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetMissingMeta(v int64) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.MissingMeta = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockLegalHoldStatus sets the ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetObjectLockLegalHoldStatus(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockMode sets the ObjectLockMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetObjectLockMode(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockRetainUntilDate sets the ObjectLockRetainUntilDate field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetObjectLockRetainUntilDate(v time.Time) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockRetainUntilDate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartsCount sets the PartsCount field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetPartsCount(v int64) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.PartsCount = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReplicationStatus sets the ReplicationStatus field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetReplicationStatus(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ReplicationStatus = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRestore sets the Restore field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetRestore(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.Restore = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSEKMSKeyId sets the SSEKMSKeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetSSEKMSKeyId(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.SSEKMSKeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerSideEncryption sets the ServerSideEncryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetServerSideEncryption(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ServerSideEncryption = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClass sets the StorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetStorageClass(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.StorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTagCount sets the TagCount field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetTagCount(v int64) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.TagCount = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetVersionId(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWebsiteRedirectLocation sets the WebsiteRedirectLocation field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectOutput) SetWebsiteRedirectLocation(v string) *GetObjectOutput {
|
|
s.WebsiteRedirectLocation = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectRetentionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The bucket containing the object whose retention settings you want to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The key name for the object whose retention settings you want to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// The version ID for the object whose retention settings you want to retrieve.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"versionId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectRetentionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectRetentionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectRetentionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetObjectRetentionInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectRetentionInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetObjectRetentionInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetObjectRetentionInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectRetentionInput) SetKey(v string) *GetObjectRetentionInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectRetentionInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *GetObjectRetentionInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectRetentionInput) SetVersionId(v string) *GetObjectRetentionInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectRetentionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"Retention"`
|
|
|
|
// The container element for an object's retention settings.
|
|
Retention *ObjectLockRetention `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectRetentionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectRetentionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRetention sets the Retention field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectRetentionOutput) SetRetention(v *ObjectLockRetention) *GetObjectRetentionOutput {
|
|
s.Retention = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectTaggingInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"versionId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectTaggingInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectTaggingInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTaggingInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetObjectTaggingInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTaggingInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetObjectTaggingInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTaggingInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTaggingInput) SetKey(v string) *GetObjectTaggingInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTaggingInput) SetVersionId(v string) *GetObjectTaggingInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectTaggingOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// TagSet is a required field
|
|
TagSet []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-version-id" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectTaggingOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectTaggingOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTagSet sets the TagSet field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTaggingOutput) SetTagSet(v []*Tag) *GetObjectTaggingOutput {
|
|
s.TagSet = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTaggingOutput) SetVersionId(v string) *GetObjectTaggingOutput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectTorrentInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectTorrentInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectTorrentInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTorrentInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetObjectTorrentInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTorrentInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetObjectTorrentInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTorrentInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTorrentInput) SetKey(v string) *GetObjectTorrentInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTorrentInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *GetObjectTorrentInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetObjectTorrentOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"Body"`
|
|
|
|
Body io.ReadCloser `type:"blob"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectTorrentOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetObjectTorrentOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBody sets the Body field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTorrentOutput) SetBody(v io.ReadCloser) *GetObjectTorrentOutput {
|
|
s.Body = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetObjectTorrentOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *GetObjectTorrentOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetPublicAccessBlockInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the Amazon S3 bucket whose PublicAccessBlock configuration you
|
|
// want to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPublicAccessBlockInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPublicAccessBlockInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GetPublicAccessBlockInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetPublicAccessBlockInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPublicAccessBlockInput) SetBucket(v string) *GetPublicAccessBlockInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *GetPublicAccessBlockInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GetPublicAccessBlockOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"PublicAccessBlockConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// The PublicAccessBlock configuration currently in effect for this Amazon S3
|
|
// bucket.
|
|
PublicAccessBlockConfiguration *PublicAccessBlockConfiguration `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPublicAccessBlockOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GetPublicAccessBlockOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPublicAccessBlockConfiguration sets the PublicAccessBlockConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *GetPublicAccessBlockOutput) SetPublicAccessBlockConfiguration(v *PublicAccessBlockConfiguration) *GetPublicAccessBlockOutput {
|
|
s.PublicAccessBlockConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GlacierJobParameters struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Glacier retrieval tier at which the restore will be processed.
|
|
//
|
|
// Tier is a required field
|
|
Tier *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"Tier"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GlacierJobParameters) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GlacierJobParameters) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GlacierJobParameters) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GlacierJobParameters"}
|
|
if s.Tier == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Tier"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTier sets the Tier field's value.
|
|
func (s *GlacierJobParameters) SetTier(v string) *GlacierJobParameters {
|
|
s.Tier = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Grant struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Grantee *Grantee `type:"structure" xmlPrefix:"xsi" xmlURI:"http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the permission given to the grantee.
|
|
Permission *string `type:"string" enum:"Permission"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Grant) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Grant) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Grant) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Grant"}
|
|
if s.Grantee != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Grantee.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Grantee", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantee sets the Grantee field's value.
|
|
func (s *Grant) SetGrantee(v *Grantee) *Grant {
|
|
s.Grantee = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPermission sets the Permission field's value.
|
|
func (s *Grant) SetPermission(v string) *Grant {
|
|
s.Permission = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Grantee struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" xmlPrefix:"xsi" xmlURI:"http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance"`
|
|
|
|
// Screen name of the grantee.
|
|
DisplayName *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Email address of the grantee.
|
|
EmailAddress *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The canonical user ID of the grantee.
|
|
ID *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Type of grantee
|
|
//
|
|
// Type is a required field
|
|
Type *string `locationName:"xsi:type" type:"string" xmlAttribute:"true" required:"true" enum:"Type"`
|
|
|
|
// URI of the grantee group.
|
|
URI *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Grantee) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Grantee) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Grantee) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Grantee"}
|
|
if s.Type == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Type"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDisplayName sets the DisplayName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Grantee) SetDisplayName(v string) *Grantee {
|
|
s.DisplayName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEmailAddress sets the EmailAddress field's value.
|
|
func (s *Grantee) SetEmailAddress(v string) *Grantee {
|
|
s.EmailAddress = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetID sets the ID field's value.
|
|
func (s *Grantee) SetID(v string) *Grantee {
|
|
s.ID = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetType sets the Type field's value.
|
|
func (s *Grantee) SetType(v string) *Grantee {
|
|
s.Type = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetURI sets the URI field's value.
|
|
func (s *Grantee) SetURI(v string) *Grantee {
|
|
s.URI = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type HeadBucketInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HeadBucketInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HeadBucketInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *HeadBucketInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "HeadBucketInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadBucketInput) SetBucket(v string) *HeadBucketInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *HeadBucketInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type HeadBucketOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HeadBucketOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HeadBucketOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type HeadObjectInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Return the object only if its entity tag (ETag) is the same as the one specified,
|
|
// otherwise return a 412 (precondition failed).
|
|
IfMatch *string `location:"header" locationName:"If-Match" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Return the object only if it has been modified since the specified time,
|
|
// otherwise return a 304 (not modified).
|
|
IfModifiedSince *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"If-Modified-Since" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Return the object only if its entity tag (ETag) is different from the one
|
|
// specified, otherwise return a 304 (not modified).
|
|
IfNoneMatch *string `location:"header" locationName:"If-None-Match" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Return the object only if it has not been modified since the specified time,
|
|
// otherwise return a 412 (precondition failed).
|
|
IfUnmodifiedSince *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"If-Unmodified-Since" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Part number of the object being read. This is a positive integer between
|
|
// 1 and 10,000. Effectively performs a 'ranged' HEAD request for the part specified.
|
|
// Useful querying about the size of the part and the number of parts in this
|
|
// object.
|
|
PartNumber *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"partNumber" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Downloads the specified range bytes of an object. For more information about
|
|
// the HTTP Range header, go to http://www.w3.org/Protocols/rfc2616/rfc2616-sec14.html#sec14.35.
|
|
Range *string `location:"header" locationName:"Range" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the algorithm to use to when encrypting the object (e.g., AES256).
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting
|
|
// data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded; Amazon
|
|
// does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with
|
|
// the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm
|
|
// header.
|
|
SSECustomerKey *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321.
|
|
// Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure the encryption
|
|
// key was transmitted without error.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// VersionId used to reference a specific version of the object.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"versionId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HeadObjectInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HeadObjectInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "HeadObjectInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) SetBucket(v string) *HeadObjectInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIfMatch sets the IfMatch field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) SetIfMatch(v string) *HeadObjectInput {
|
|
s.IfMatch = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIfModifiedSince sets the IfModifiedSince field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) SetIfModifiedSince(v time.Time) *HeadObjectInput {
|
|
s.IfModifiedSince = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIfNoneMatch sets the IfNoneMatch field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) SetIfNoneMatch(v string) *HeadObjectInput {
|
|
s.IfNoneMatch = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIfUnmodifiedSince sets the IfUnmodifiedSince field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) SetIfUnmodifiedSince(v time.Time) *HeadObjectInput {
|
|
s.IfUnmodifiedSince = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) SetKey(v string) *HeadObjectInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartNumber sets the PartNumber field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) SetPartNumber(v int64) *HeadObjectInput {
|
|
s.PartNumber = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRange sets the Range field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) SetRange(v string) *HeadObjectInput {
|
|
s.Range = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *HeadObjectInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *HeadObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKey sets the SSECustomerKey field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) SetSSECustomerKey(v string) *HeadObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKey = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) getSSECustomerKey() (v string) {
|
|
if s.SSECustomerKey == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.SSECustomerKey
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *HeadObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectInput) SetVersionId(v string) *HeadObjectInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type HeadObjectOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
AcceptRanges *string `location:"header" locationName:"accept-ranges" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies caching behavior along the request/reply chain.
|
|
CacheControl *string `location:"header" locationName:"Cache-Control" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies presentational information for the object.
|
|
ContentDisposition *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Disposition" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies what content encodings have been applied to the object and thus
|
|
// what decoding mechanisms must be applied to obtain the media-type referenced
|
|
// by the Content-Type header field.
|
|
ContentEncoding *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Encoding" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The language the content is in.
|
|
ContentLanguage *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Language" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Size of the body in bytes.
|
|
ContentLength *int64 `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Length" type:"long"`
|
|
|
|
// A standard MIME type describing the format of the object data.
|
|
ContentType *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Type" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether the object retrieved was (true) or was not (false) a Delete
|
|
// Marker. If false, this response header does not appear in the response.
|
|
DeleteMarker *bool `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-delete-marker" type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// An ETag is an opaque identifier assigned by a web server to a specific version
|
|
// of a resource found at a URL
|
|
ETag *string `location:"header" locationName:"ETag" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the object expiration is configured (see PUT Bucket lifecycle), the response
|
|
// includes this header. It includes the expiry-date and rule-id key value pairs
|
|
// providing object expiration information. The value of the rule-id is URL
|
|
// encoded.
|
|
Expiration *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-expiration" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The date and time at which the object is no longer cacheable.
|
|
Expires *string `location:"header" locationName:"Expires" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Last modified date of the object
|
|
LastModified *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"Last-Modified" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// A map of metadata to store with the object in S3.
|
|
Metadata map[string]*string `location:"headers" locationName:"x-amz-meta-" type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// This is set to the number of metadata entries not returned in x-amz-meta
|
|
// headers. This can happen if you create metadata using an API like SOAP that
|
|
// supports more flexible metadata than the REST API. For example, using SOAP,
|
|
// you can create metadata whose values are not legal HTTP headers.
|
|
MissingMeta *int64 `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-missing-meta" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The Legal Hold status for the specified object.
|
|
ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-legal-hold" type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus"`
|
|
|
|
// The Object Lock mode currently in place for this object.
|
|
ObjectLockMode *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-mode" type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockMode"`
|
|
|
|
// The date and time when this object's Object Lock will expire.
|
|
ObjectLockRetainUntilDate *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-retain-until-date" type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
|
|
|
|
// The count of parts this object has.
|
|
PartsCount *int64 `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-mp-parts-count" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
ReplicationStatus *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-replication-status" type:"string" enum:"ReplicationStatus"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
|
|
// Provides information about object restoration operation and expiration time
|
|
// of the restored object copy.
|
|
Restore *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-restore" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header confirming the encryption algorithm
|
|
// used.
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header to provide round trip message integrity
|
|
// verification of the customer-provided encryption key.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, specifies the ID of the AWS Key Management Service (KMS) master
|
|
// encryption key that was used for the object.
|
|
SSEKMSKeyId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The Server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
|
|
// (e.g., AES256, aws:kms).
|
|
ServerSideEncryption *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption" type:"string" enum:"ServerSideEncryption"`
|
|
|
|
StorageClass *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-storage-class" type:"string" enum:"StorageClass"`
|
|
|
|
// Version of the object.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-version-id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the bucket is configured as a website, redirects requests for this object
|
|
// to another object in the same bucket or to an external URL. Amazon S3 stores
|
|
// the value of this header in the object metadata.
|
|
WebsiteRedirectLocation *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-website-redirect-location" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HeadObjectOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HeadObjectOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAcceptRanges sets the AcceptRanges field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetAcceptRanges(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.AcceptRanges = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCacheControl sets the CacheControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetCacheControl(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.CacheControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentDisposition sets the ContentDisposition field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetContentDisposition(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ContentDisposition = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentEncoding sets the ContentEncoding field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetContentEncoding(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ContentEncoding = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentLanguage sets the ContentLanguage field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetContentLanguage(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ContentLanguage = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentLength sets the ContentLength field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetContentLength(v int64) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ContentLength = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentType sets the ContentType field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetContentType(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ContentType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeleteMarker sets the DeleteMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetDeleteMarker(v bool) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.DeleteMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetETag sets the ETag field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetETag(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ETag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpiration sets the Expiration field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetExpiration(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.Expiration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpires sets the Expires field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetExpires(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.Expires = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastModified sets the LastModified field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetLastModified(v time.Time) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.LastModified = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMetadata sets the Metadata field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetMetadata(v map[string]*string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.Metadata = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMissingMeta sets the MissingMeta field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetMissingMeta(v int64) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.MissingMeta = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockLegalHoldStatus sets the ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetObjectLockLegalHoldStatus(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockMode sets the ObjectLockMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetObjectLockMode(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockRetainUntilDate sets the ObjectLockRetainUntilDate field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetObjectLockRetainUntilDate(v time.Time) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockRetainUntilDate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartsCount sets the PartsCount field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetPartsCount(v int64) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.PartsCount = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReplicationStatus sets the ReplicationStatus field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetReplicationStatus(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ReplicationStatus = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRestore sets the Restore field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetRestore(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.Restore = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSEKMSKeyId sets the SSEKMSKeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetSSEKMSKeyId(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.SSEKMSKeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerSideEncryption sets the ServerSideEncryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetServerSideEncryption(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ServerSideEncryption = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClass sets the StorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetStorageClass(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.StorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetVersionId(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWebsiteRedirectLocation sets the WebsiteRedirectLocation field's value.
|
|
func (s *HeadObjectOutput) SetWebsiteRedirectLocation(v string) *HeadObjectOutput {
|
|
s.WebsiteRedirectLocation = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type IndexDocument struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A suffix that is appended to a request that is for a directory on the website
|
|
// endpoint (e.g. if the suffix is index.html and you make a request to samplebucket/images/
|
|
// the data that is returned will be for the object with the key name images/index.html)
|
|
// The suffix must not be empty and must not include a slash character.
|
|
//
|
|
// Suffix is a required field
|
|
Suffix *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s IndexDocument) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s IndexDocument) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *IndexDocument) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "IndexDocument"}
|
|
if s.Suffix == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Suffix"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSuffix sets the Suffix field's value.
|
|
func (s *IndexDocument) SetSuffix(v string) *IndexDocument {
|
|
s.Suffix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Initiator struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the Principal.
|
|
DisplayName *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the principal is an AWS account, it provides the Canonical User ID. If
|
|
// the principal is an IAM User, it provides a user ARN value.
|
|
ID *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Initiator) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Initiator) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDisplayName sets the DisplayName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Initiator) SetDisplayName(v string) *Initiator {
|
|
s.DisplayName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetID sets the ID field's value.
|
|
func (s *Initiator) SetID(v string) *Initiator {
|
|
s.ID = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Describes the serialization format of the object.
|
|
type InputSerialization struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Describes the serialization of a CSV-encoded object.
|
|
CSV *CSVInput `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies object's compression format. Valid values: NONE, GZIP, BZIP2. Default
|
|
// Value: NONE.
|
|
CompressionType *string `type:"string" enum:"CompressionType"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies JSON as object's input serialization format.
|
|
JSON *JSONInput `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies Parquet as object's input serialization format.
|
|
Parquet *ParquetInput `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSerialization) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSerialization) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCSV sets the CSV field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSerialization) SetCSV(v *CSVInput) *InputSerialization {
|
|
s.CSV = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCompressionType sets the CompressionType field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSerialization) SetCompressionType(v string) *InputSerialization {
|
|
s.CompressionType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJSON sets the JSON field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSerialization) SetJSON(v *JSONInput) *InputSerialization {
|
|
s.JSON = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParquet sets the Parquet field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSerialization) SetParquet(v *ParquetInput) *InputSerialization {
|
|
s.Parquet = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type InventoryConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Contains information about where to publish the inventory results.
|
|
//
|
|
// Destination is a required field
|
|
Destination *InventoryDestination `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies an inventory filter. The inventory only includes objects that meet
|
|
// the filter's criteria.
|
|
Filter *InventoryFilter `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID used to identify the inventory configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Id is a required field
|
|
Id *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies which object version(s) to included in the inventory results.
|
|
//
|
|
// IncludedObjectVersions is a required field
|
|
IncludedObjectVersions *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"InventoryIncludedObjectVersions"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether the inventory is enabled or disabled.
|
|
//
|
|
// IsEnabled is a required field
|
|
IsEnabled *bool `type:"boolean" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Contains the optional fields that are included in the inventory results.
|
|
OptionalFields []*string `locationNameList:"Field" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the schedule for generating inventory results.
|
|
//
|
|
// Schedule is a required field
|
|
Schedule *InventorySchedule `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InventoryConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InventoryConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *InventoryConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InventoryConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.Destination == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Id == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.IncludedObjectVersions == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("IncludedObjectVersions"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.IsEnabled == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("IsEnabled"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Schedule == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Schedule"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Destination != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Destination.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Destination", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Filter != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Filter.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Filter", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Schedule != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Schedule.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Schedule", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestination sets the Destination field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryConfiguration) SetDestination(v *InventoryDestination) *InventoryConfiguration {
|
|
s.Destination = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilter sets the Filter field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryConfiguration) SetFilter(v *InventoryFilter) *InventoryConfiguration {
|
|
s.Filter = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryConfiguration) SetId(v string) *InventoryConfiguration {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIncludedObjectVersions sets the IncludedObjectVersions field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryConfiguration) SetIncludedObjectVersions(v string) *InventoryConfiguration {
|
|
s.IncludedObjectVersions = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIsEnabled sets the IsEnabled field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryConfiguration) SetIsEnabled(v bool) *InventoryConfiguration {
|
|
s.IsEnabled = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOptionalFields sets the OptionalFields field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryConfiguration) SetOptionalFields(v []*string) *InventoryConfiguration {
|
|
s.OptionalFields = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSchedule sets the Schedule field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryConfiguration) SetSchedule(v *InventorySchedule) *InventoryConfiguration {
|
|
s.Schedule = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type InventoryDestination struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Contains the bucket name, file format, bucket owner (optional), and prefix
|
|
// (optional) where inventory results are published.
|
|
//
|
|
// S3BucketDestination is a required field
|
|
S3BucketDestination *InventoryS3BucketDestination `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InventoryDestination) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InventoryDestination) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *InventoryDestination) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InventoryDestination"}
|
|
if s.S3BucketDestination == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("S3BucketDestination"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.S3BucketDestination != nil {
|
|
if err := s.S3BucketDestination.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("S3BucketDestination", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetS3BucketDestination sets the S3BucketDestination field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryDestination) SetS3BucketDestination(v *InventoryS3BucketDestination) *InventoryDestination {
|
|
s.S3BucketDestination = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Contains the type of server-side encryption used to encrypt the inventory
|
|
// results.
|
|
type InventoryEncryption struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the use of SSE-KMS to encrypt delivered Inventory reports.
|
|
SSEKMS *SSEKMS `locationName:"SSE-KMS" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the use of SSE-S3 to encrypt delivered Inventory reports.
|
|
SSES3 *SSES3 `locationName:"SSE-S3" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InventoryEncryption) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InventoryEncryption) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *InventoryEncryption) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InventoryEncryption"}
|
|
if s.SSEKMS != nil {
|
|
if err := s.SSEKMS.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("SSEKMS", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSEKMS sets the SSEKMS field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryEncryption) SetSSEKMS(v *SSEKMS) *InventoryEncryption {
|
|
s.SSEKMS = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSES3 sets the SSES3 field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryEncryption) SetSSES3(v *SSES3) *InventoryEncryption {
|
|
s.SSES3 = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type InventoryFilter struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The prefix that an object must have to be included in the inventory results.
|
|
//
|
|
// Prefix is a required field
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InventoryFilter) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InventoryFilter) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *InventoryFilter) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InventoryFilter"}
|
|
if s.Prefix == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Prefix"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryFilter) SetPrefix(v string) *InventoryFilter {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type InventoryS3BucketDestination struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the account that owns the destination bucket.
|
|
AccountId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The Amazon resource name (ARN) of the bucket where inventory results will
|
|
// be published.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Contains the type of server-side encryption used to encrypt the inventory
|
|
// results.
|
|
Encryption *InventoryEncryption `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the output format of the inventory results.
|
|
//
|
|
// Format is a required field
|
|
Format *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"InventoryFormat"`
|
|
|
|
// The prefix that is prepended to all inventory results.
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InventoryS3BucketDestination) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InventoryS3BucketDestination) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *InventoryS3BucketDestination) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InventoryS3BucketDestination"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Format == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Format"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Encryption != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Encryption.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Encryption", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAccountId sets the AccountId field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryS3BucketDestination) SetAccountId(v string) *InventoryS3BucketDestination {
|
|
s.AccountId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryS3BucketDestination) SetBucket(v string) *InventoryS3BucketDestination {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *InventoryS3BucketDestination) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncryption sets the Encryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryS3BucketDestination) SetEncryption(v *InventoryEncryption) *InventoryS3BucketDestination {
|
|
s.Encryption = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFormat sets the Format field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryS3BucketDestination) SetFormat(v string) *InventoryS3BucketDestination {
|
|
s.Format = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventoryS3BucketDestination) SetPrefix(v string) *InventoryS3BucketDestination {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type InventorySchedule struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies how frequently inventory results are produced.
|
|
//
|
|
// Frequency is a required field
|
|
Frequency *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"InventoryFrequency"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InventorySchedule) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InventorySchedule) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *InventorySchedule) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InventorySchedule"}
|
|
if s.Frequency == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Frequency"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFrequency sets the Frequency field's value.
|
|
func (s *InventorySchedule) SetFrequency(v string) *InventorySchedule {
|
|
s.Frequency = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type JSONInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of JSON. Valid values: Document, Lines.
|
|
Type *string `type:"string" enum:"JSONType"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JSONInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JSONInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetType sets the Type field's value.
|
|
func (s *JSONInput) SetType(v string) *JSONInput {
|
|
s.Type = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type JSONOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The value used to separate individual records in the output.
|
|
RecordDelimiter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JSONOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s JSONOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRecordDelimiter sets the RecordDelimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *JSONOutput) SetRecordDelimiter(v string) *JSONOutput {
|
|
s.RecordDelimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for object key name prefix and suffix filtering rules.
|
|
type KeyFilter struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of containers for the key value pair that defines the criteria for
|
|
// the filter rule.
|
|
FilterRules []*FilterRule `locationName:"FilterRule" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s KeyFilter) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s KeyFilter) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilterRules sets the FilterRules field's value.
|
|
func (s *KeyFilter) SetFilterRules(v []*FilterRule) *KeyFilter {
|
|
s.FilterRules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for specifying the configuration for AWS Lambda notifications.
|
|
type LambdaFunctionConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Events is a required field
|
|
Events []*string `locationName:"Event" type:"list" flattened:"true" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for object key name filtering rules. For information about key
|
|
// name filtering, see Configuring Event Notifications (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/NotificationHowTo.html)
|
|
// in the Amazon Simple Storage Service Developer Guide.
|
|
Filter *NotificationConfigurationFilter `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An optional unique identifier for configurations in a notification configuration.
|
|
// If you don't provide one, Amazon S3 will assign an ID.
|
|
Id *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the Lambda cloud function that Amazon S3
|
|
// can invoke when it detects events of the specified type.
|
|
//
|
|
// LambdaFunctionArn is a required field
|
|
LambdaFunctionArn *string `locationName:"CloudFunction" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LambdaFunctionConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LambdaFunctionConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *LambdaFunctionConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "LambdaFunctionConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.Events == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Events"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.LambdaFunctionArn == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("LambdaFunctionArn"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEvents sets the Events field's value.
|
|
func (s *LambdaFunctionConfiguration) SetEvents(v []*string) *LambdaFunctionConfiguration {
|
|
s.Events = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilter sets the Filter field's value.
|
|
func (s *LambdaFunctionConfiguration) SetFilter(v *NotificationConfigurationFilter) *LambdaFunctionConfiguration {
|
|
s.Filter = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *LambdaFunctionConfiguration) SetId(v string) *LambdaFunctionConfiguration {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLambdaFunctionArn sets the LambdaFunctionArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *LambdaFunctionConfiguration) SetLambdaFunctionArn(v string) *LambdaFunctionConfiguration {
|
|
s.LambdaFunctionArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type LifecycleConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Rules is a required field
|
|
Rules []*Rule `locationName:"Rule" type:"list" flattened:"true" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LifecycleConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LifecycleConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "LifecycleConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.Rules == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Rules"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Rules != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Rules {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Rules", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRules sets the Rules field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleConfiguration) SetRules(v []*Rule) *LifecycleConfiguration {
|
|
s.Rules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type LifecycleExpiration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates at what date the object is to be moved or deleted. Should be in
|
|
// GMT ISO 8601 Format.
|
|
Date *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates the lifetime, in days, of the objects that are subject to the rule.
|
|
// The value must be a non-zero positive integer.
|
|
Days *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether Amazon S3 will remove a delete marker with no noncurrent
|
|
// versions. If set to true, the delete marker will be expired; if set to false
|
|
// the policy takes no action. This cannot be specified with Days or Date in
|
|
// a Lifecycle Expiration Policy.
|
|
ExpiredObjectDeleteMarker *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LifecycleExpiration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LifecycleExpiration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDate sets the Date field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleExpiration) SetDate(v time.Time) *LifecycleExpiration {
|
|
s.Date = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDays sets the Days field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleExpiration) SetDays(v int64) *LifecycleExpiration {
|
|
s.Days = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpiredObjectDeleteMarker sets the ExpiredObjectDeleteMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleExpiration) SetExpiredObjectDeleteMarker(v bool) *LifecycleExpiration {
|
|
s.ExpiredObjectDeleteMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type LifecycleRule struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the days since the initiation of an Incomplete Multipart Upload
|
|
// that Lifecycle will wait before permanently removing all parts of the upload.
|
|
AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload *AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Expiration *LifecycleExpiration `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The Filter is used to identify objects that a Lifecycle Rule applies to.
|
|
// A Filter must have exactly one of Prefix, Tag, or And specified.
|
|
Filter *LifecycleRuleFilter `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Unique identifier for the rule. The value cannot be longer than 255 characters.
|
|
ID *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies when noncurrent object versions expire. Upon expiration, Amazon
|
|
// S3 permanently deletes the noncurrent object versions. You set this lifecycle
|
|
// configuration action on a bucket that has versioning enabled (or suspended)
|
|
// to request that Amazon S3 delete noncurrent object versions at a specific
|
|
// period in the object's lifetime.
|
|
NoncurrentVersionExpiration *NoncurrentVersionExpiration `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
NoncurrentVersionTransitions []*NoncurrentVersionTransition `locationName:"NoncurrentVersionTransition" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Prefix identifying one or more objects to which the rule applies. This is
|
|
// No longer used; use Filter instead.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: Prefix has been deprecated
|
|
Prefix *string `deprecated:"true" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If 'Enabled', the rule is currently being applied. If 'Disabled', the rule
|
|
// is not currently being applied.
|
|
//
|
|
// Status is a required field
|
|
Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"ExpirationStatus"`
|
|
|
|
Transitions []*Transition `locationName:"Transition" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LifecycleRule) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LifecycleRule) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRule) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "LifecycleRule"}
|
|
if s.Status == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Status"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Filter != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Filter.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Filter", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAbortIncompleteMultipartUpload sets the AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRule) SetAbortIncompleteMultipartUpload(v *AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload) *LifecycleRule {
|
|
s.AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpiration sets the Expiration field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRule) SetExpiration(v *LifecycleExpiration) *LifecycleRule {
|
|
s.Expiration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilter sets the Filter field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRule) SetFilter(v *LifecycleRuleFilter) *LifecycleRule {
|
|
s.Filter = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetID sets the ID field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRule) SetID(v string) *LifecycleRule {
|
|
s.ID = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNoncurrentVersionExpiration sets the NoncurrentVersionExpiration field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRule) SetNoncurrentVersionExpiration(v *NoncurrentVersionExpiration) *LifecycleRule {
|
|
s.NoncurrentVersionExpiration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNoncurrentVersionTransitions sets the NoncurrentVersionTransitions field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRule) SetNoncurrentVersionTransitions(v []*NoncurrentVersionTransition) *LifecycleRule {
|
|
s.NoncurrentVersionTransitions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRule) SetPrefix(v string) *LifecycleRule {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRule) SetStatus(v string) *LifecycleRule {
|
|
s.Status = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTransitions sets the Transitions field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRule) SetTransitions(v []*Transition) *LifecycleRule {
|
|
s.Transitions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// This is used in a Lifecycle Rule Filter to apply a logical AND to two or
|
|
// more predicates. The Lifecycle Rule will apply to any object matching all
|
|
// of the predicates configured inside the And operator.
|
|
type LifecycleRuleAndOperator struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// All of these tags must exist in the object's tag set in order for the rule
|
|
// to apply.
|
|
Tags []*Tag `locationName:"Tag" locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LifecycleRuleAndOperator) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LifecycleRuleAndOperator) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRuleAndOperator) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "LifecycleRuleAndOperator"}
|
|
if s.Tags != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Tags {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Tags", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRuleAndOperator) SetPrefix(v string) *LifecycleRuleAndOperator {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRuleAndOperator) SetTags(v []*Tag) *LifecycleRuleAndOperator {
|
|
s.Tags = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The Filter is used to identify objects that a Lifecycle Rule applies to.
|
|
// A Filter must have exactly one of Prefix, Tag, or And specified.
|
|
type LifecycleRuleFilter struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// This is used in a Lifecycle Rule Filter to apply a logical AND to two or
|
|
// more predicates. The Lifecycle Rule will apply to any object matching all
|
|
// of the predicates configured inside the And operator.
|
|
And *LifecycleRuleAndOperator `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Prefix identifying one or more objects to which the rule applies.
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// This tag must exist in the object's tag set in order for the rule to apply.
|
|
Tag *Tag `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LifecycleRuleFilter) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LifecycleRuleFilter) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRuleFilter) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "LifecycleRuleFilter"}
|
|
if s.And != nil {
|
|
if err := s.And.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("And", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Tag != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Tag.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Tag", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAnd sets the And field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRuleFilter) SetAnd(v *LifecycleRuleAndOperator) *LifecycleRuleFilter {
|
|
s.And = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRuleFilter) SetPrefix(v string) *LifecycleRuleFilter {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTag sets the Tag field's value.
|
|
func (s *LifecycleRuleFilter) SetTag(v *Tag) *LifecycleRuleFilter {
|
|
s.Tag = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket from which analytics configurations are retrieved.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The ContinuationToken that represents a placeholder from where this request
|
|
// should begin.
|
|
ContinuationToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"continuation-token" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput) SetBucket(v string) *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContinuationToken sets the ContinuationToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput) SetContinuationToken(v string) *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsInput {
|
|
s.ContinuationToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The list of analytics configurations for a bucket.
|
|
AnalyticsConfigurationList []*AnalyticsConfiguration `locationName:"AnalyticsConfiguration" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The ContinuationToken that represents where this request began.
|
|
ContinuationToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether the returned list of analytics configurations is complete.
|
|
// A value of true indicates that the list is not complete and the NextContinuationToken
|
|
// will be provided for a subsequent request.
|
|
IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// NextContinuationToken is sent when isTruncated is true, which indicates that
|
|
// there are more analytics configurations to list. The next request must include
|
|
// this NextContinuationToken. The token is obfuscated and is not a usable value.
|
|
NextContinuationToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAnalyticsConfigurationList sets the AnalyticsConfigurationList field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput) SetAnalyticsConfigurationList(v []*AnalyticsConfiguration) *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.AnalyticsConfigurationList = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContinuationToken sets the ContinuationToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput) SetContinuationToken(v string) *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.ContinuationToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.IsTruncated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextContinuationToken sets the NextContinuationToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput) SetNextContinuationToken(v string) *ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.NextContinuationToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket containing the inventory configurations to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The marker used to continue an inventory configuration listing that has been
|
|
// truncated. Use the NextContinuationToken from a previously truncated list
|
|
// response to continue the listing. The continuation token is an opaque value
|
|
// that Amazon S3 understands.
|
|
ContinuationToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"continuation-token" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput) SetBucket(v string) *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContinuationToken sets the ContinuationToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput) SetContinuationToken(v string) *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsInput {
|
|
s.ContinuationToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If sent in the request, the marker that is used as a starting point for this
|
|
// inventory configuration list response.
|
|
ContinuationToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The list of inventory configurations for a bucket.
|
|
InventoryConfigurationList []*InventoryConfiguration `locationName:"InventoryConfiguration" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether the returned list of inventory configurations is truncated
|
|
// in this response. A value of true indicates that the list is truncated.
|
|
IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The marker used to continue this inventory configuration listing. Use the
|
|
// NextContinuationToken from this response to continue the listing in a subsequent
|
|
// request. The continuation token is an opaque value that Amazon S3 understands.
|
|
NextContinuationToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContinuationToken sets the ContinuationToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput) SetContinuationToken(v string) *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.ContinuationToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInventoryConfigurationList sets the InventoryConfigurationList field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput) SetInventoryConfigurationList(v []*InventoryConfiguration) *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.InventoryConfigurationList = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.IsTruncated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextContinuationToken sets the NextContinuationToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput) SetNextContinuationToken(v string) *ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.NextContinuationToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket containing the metrics configurations to retrieve.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The marker that is used to continue a metrics configuration listing that
|
|
// has been truncated. Use the NextContinuationToken from a previously truncated
|
|
// list response to continue the listing. The continuation token is an opaque
|
|
// value that Amazon S3 understands.
|
|
ContinuationToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"continuation-token" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput) SetBucket(v string) *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContinuationToken sets the ContinuationToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput) SetContinuationToken(v string) *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsInput {
|
|
s.ContinuationToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The marker that is used as a starting point for this metrics configuration
|
|
// list response. This value is present if it was sent in the request.
|
|
ContinuationToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether the returned list of metrics configurations is complete.
|
|
// A value of true indicates that the list is not complete and the NextContinuationToken
|
|
// will be provided for a subsequent request.
|
|
IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The list of metrics configurations for a bucket.
|
|
MetricsConfigurationList []*MetricsConfiguration `locationName:"MetricsConfiguration" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The marker used to continue a metrics configuration listing that has been
|
|
// truncated. Use the NextContinuationToken from a previously truncated list
|
|
// response to continue the listing. The continuation token is an opaque value
|
|
// that Amazon S3 understands.
|
|
NextContinuationToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContinuationToken sets the ContinuationToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput) SetContinuationToken(v string) *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.ContinuationToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.IsTruncated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMetricsConfigurationList sets the MetricsConfigurationList field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput) SetMetricsConfigurationList(v []*MetricsConfiguration) *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.MetricsConfigurationList = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextContinuationToken sets the NextContinuationToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput) SetNextContinuationToken(v string) *ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput {
|
|
s.NextContinuationToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListBucketsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListBucketsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Buckets []*Bucket `locationNameList:"Bucket" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
Owner *Owner `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListBucketsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBuckets sets the Buckets field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketsOutput) SetBuckets(v []*Bucket) *ListBucketsOutput {
|
|
s.Buckets = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwner sets the Owner field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListBucketsOutput) SetOwner(v *Owner) *ListBucketsOutput {
|
|
s.Owner = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListMultipartUploadsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Character you use to group keys.
|
|
Delimiter *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"delimiter" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Requests Amazon S3 to encode the object keys in the response and specifies
|
|
// the encoding method to use. An object key may contain any Unicode character;
|
|
// however, XML 1.0 parser cannot parse some characters, such as characters
|
|
// with an ASCII value from 0 to 10. For characters that are not supported in
|
|
// XML 1.0, you can add this parameter to request that Amazon S3 encode the
|
|
// keys in the response.
|
|
EncodingType *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"encoding-type" type:"string" enum:"EncodingType"`
|
|
|
|
// Together with upload-id-marker, this parameter specifies the multipart upload
|
|
// after which listing should begin.
|
|
KeyMarker *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"key-marker" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the maximum number of multipart uploads, from 1 to 1,000, to return
|
|
// in the response body. 1,000 is the maximum number of uploads that can be
|
|
// returned in a response.
|
|
MaxUploads *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"max-uploads" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Lists in-progress uploads only for those keys that begin with the specified
|
|
// prefix.
|
|
Prefix *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"prefix" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Together with key-marker, specifies the multipart upload after which listing
|
|
// should begin. If key-marker is not specified, the upload-id-marker parameter
|
|
// is ignored.
|
|
UploadIdMarker *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"upload-id-marker" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListMultipartUploadsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListMultipartUploadsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListMultipartUploadsInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsInput) SetBucket(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDelimiter sets the Delimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsInput) SetDelimiter(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsInput {
|
|
s.Delimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncodingType sets the EncodingType field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsInput) SetEncodingType(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsInput {
|
|
s.EncodingType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKeyMarker sets the KeyMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsInput) SetKeyMarker(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsInput {
|
|
s.KeyMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxUploads sets the MaxUploads field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsInput) SetMaxUploads(v int64) *ListMultipartUploadsInput {
|
|
s.MaxUploads = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsInput) SetPrefix(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsInput {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUploadIdMarker sets the UploadIdMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsInput) SetUploadIdMarker(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsInput {
|
|
s.UploadIdMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListMultipartUploadsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the bucket to which the multipart upload was initiated.
|
|
Bucket *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
CommonPrefixes []*CommonPrefix `type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
Delimiter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Encoding type used by Amazon S3 to encode object keys in the response.
|
|
EncodingType *string `type:"string" enum:"EncodingType"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether the returned list of multipart uploads is truncated. A
|
|
// value of true indicates that the list was truncated. The list can be truncated
|
|
// if the number of multipart uploads exceeds the limit allowed or specified
|
|
// by max uploads.
|
|
IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The key at or after which the listing began.
|
|
KeyMarker *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Maximum number of multipart uploads that could have been included in the
|
|
// response.
|
|
MaxUploads *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When a list is truncated, this element specifies the value that should be
|
|
// used for the key-marker request parameter in a subsequent request.
|
|
NextKeyMarker *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// When a list is truncated, this element specifies the value that should be
|
|
// used for the upload-id-marker request parameter in a subsequent request.
|
|
NextUploadIdMarker *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// When a prefix is provided in the request, this field contains the specified
|
|
// prefix. The result contains only keys starting with the specified prefix.
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Upload ID after which listing began.
|
|
UploadIdMarker *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Uploads []*MultipartUpload `locationName:"Upload" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListMultipartUploadsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListMultipartUploadsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) SetBucket(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsOutput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCommonPrefixes sets the CommonPrefixes field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) SetCommonPrefixes(v []*CommonPrefix) *ListMultipartUploadsOutput {
|
|
s.CommonPrefixes = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDelimiter sets the Delimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) SetDelimiter(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsOutput {
|
|
s.Delimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncodingType sets the EncodingType field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) SetEncodingType(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsOutput {
|
|
s.EncodingType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListMultipartUploadsOutput {
|
|
s.IsTruncated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKeyMarker sets the KeyMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) SetKeyMarker(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsOutput {
|
|
s.KeyMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxUploads sets the MaxUploads field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) SetMaxUploads(v int64) *ListMultipartUploadsOutput {
|
|
s.MaxUploads = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextKeyMarker sets the NextKeyMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) SetNextKeyMarker(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsOutput {
|
|
s.NextKeyMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextUploadIdMarker sets the NextUploadIdMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) SetNextUploadIdMarker(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsOutput {
|
|
s.NextUploadIdMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) SetPrefix(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsOutput {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUploadIdMarker sets the UploadIdMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) SetUploadIdMarker(v string) *ListMultipartUploadsOutput {
|
|
s.UploadIdMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUploads sets the Uploads field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListMultipartUploadsOutput) SetUploads(v []*MultipartUpload) *ListMultipartUploadsOutput {
|
|
s.Uploads = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListObjectVersionsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A delimiter is a character you use to group keys.
|
|
Delimiter *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"delimiter" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Requests Amazon S3 to encode the object keys in the response and specifies
|
|
// the encoding method to use. An object key may contain any Unicode character;
|
|
// however, XML 1.0 parser cannot parse some characters, such as characters
|
|
// with an ASCII value from 0 to 10. For characters that are not supported in
|
|
// XML 1.0, you can add this parameter to request that Amazon S3 encode the
|
|
// keys in the response.
|
|
EncodingType *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"encoding-type" type:"string" enum:"EncodingType"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the key to start with when listing objects in a bucket.
|
|
KeyMarker *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"key-marker" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the maximum number of keys returned in the response. The response might
|
|
// contain fewer keys but will never contain more.
|
|
MaxKeys *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"max-keys" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Limits the response to keys that begin with the specified prefix.
|
|
Prefix *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"prefix" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the object version you want to start listing from.
|
|
VersionIdMarker *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"version-id-marker" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListObjectVersionsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListObjectVersionsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListObjectVersionsInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsInput) SetBucket(v string) *ListObjectVersionsInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDelimiter sets the Delimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsInput) SetDelimiter(v string) *ListObjectVersionsInput {
|
|
s.Delimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncodingType sets the EncodingType field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsInput) SetEncodingType(v string) *ListObjectVersionsInput {
|
|
s.EncodingType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKeyMarker sets the KeyMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsInput) SetKeyMarker(v string) *ListObjectVersionsInput {
|
|
s.KeyMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxKeys sets the MaxKeys field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsInput) SetMaxKeys(v int64) *ListObjectVersionsInput {
|
|
s.MaxKeys = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsInput) SetPrefix(v string) *ListObjectVersionsInput {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionIdMarker sets the VersionIdMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsInput) SetVersionIdMarker(v string) *ListObjectVersionsInput {
|
|
s.VersionIdMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListObjectVersionsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
CommonPrefixes []*CommonPrefix `type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
DeleteMarkers []*DeleteMarkerEntry `locationName:"DeleteMarker" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
Delimiter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Encoding type used by Amazon S3 to encode object keys in the response.
|
|
EncodingType *string `type:"string" enum:"EncodingType"`
|
|
|
|
// A flag that indicates whether or not Amazon S3 returned all of the results
|
|
// that satisfied the search criteria. If your results were truncated, you can
|
|
// make a follow-up paginated request using the NextKeyMarker and NextVersionIdMarker
|
|
// response parameters as a starting place in another request to return the
|
|
// rest of the results.
|
|
IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// Marks the last Key returned in a truncated response.
|
|
KeyMarker *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
MaxKeys *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Use this value for the key marker request parameter in a subsequent request.
|
|
NextKeyMarker *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Use this value for the next version id marker parameter in a subsequent request.
|
|
NextVersionIdMarker *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
VersionIdMarker *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Versions []*ObjectVersion `locationName:"Version" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListObjectVersionsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListObjectVersionsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCommonPrefixes sets the CommonPrefixes field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsOutput) SetCommonPrefixes(v []*CommonPrefix) *ListObjectVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.CommonPrefixes = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeleteMarkers sets the DeleteMarkers field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsOutput) SetDeleteMarkers(v []*DeleteMarkerEntry) *ListObjectVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.DeleteMarkers = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDelimiter sets the Delimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsOutput) SetDelimiter(v string) *ListObjectVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.Delimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncodingType sets the EncodingType field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsOutput) SetEncodingType(v string) *ListObjectVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.EncodingType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListObjectVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.IsTruncated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKeyMarker sets the KeyMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsOutput) SetKeyMarker(v string) *ListObjectVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.KeyMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxKeys sets the MaxKeys field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsOutput) SetMaxKeys(v int64) *ListObjectVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.MaxKeys = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsOutput) SetName(v string) *ListObjectVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextKeyMarker sets the NextKeyMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsOutput) SetNextKeyMarker(v string) *ListObjectVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.NextKeyMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextVersionIdMarker sets the NextVersionIdMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsOutput) SetNextVersionIdMarker(v string) *ListObjectVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.NextVersionIdMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsOutput) SetPrefix(v string) *ListObjectVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionIdMarker sets the VersionIdMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsOutput) SetVersionIdMarker(v string) *ListObjectVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.VersionIdMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersions sets the Versions field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectVersionsOutput) SetVersions(v []*ObjectVersion) *ListObjectVersionsOutput {
|
|
s.Versions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListObjectsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A delimiter is a character you use to group keys.
|
|
Delimiter *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"delimiter" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Requests Amazon S3 to encode the object keys in the response and specifies
|
|
// the encoding method to use. An object key may contain any Unicode character;
|
|
// however, XML 1.0 parser cannot parse some characters, such as characters
|
|
// with an ASCII value from 0 to 10. For characters that are not supported in
|
|
// XML 1.0, you can add this parameter to request that Amazon S3 encode the
|
|
// keys in the response.
|
|
EncodingType *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"encoding-type" type:"string" enum:"EncodingType"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the key to start with when listing objects in a bucket.
|
|
Marker *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"marker" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the maximum number of keys returned in the response. The response might
|
|
// contain fewer keys but will never contain more.
|
|
MaxKeys *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"max-keys" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Limits the response to keys that begin with the specified prefix.
|
|
Prefix *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"prefix" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// list objects request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their
|
|
// requests.
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListObjectsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListObjectsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListObjectsInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsInput) SetBucket(v string) *ListObjectsInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDelimiter sets the Delimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsInput) SetDelimiter(v string) *ListObjectsInput {
|
|
s.Delimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncodingType sets the EncodingType field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsInput) SetEncodingType(v string) *ListObjectsInput {
|
|
s.EncodingType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsInput) SetMarker(v string) *ListObjectsInput {
|
|
s.Marker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxKeys sets the MaxKeys field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsInput) SetMaxKeys(v int64) *ListObjectsInput {
|
|
s.MaxKeys = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsInput) SetPrefix(v string) *ListObjectsInput {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *ListObjectsInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListObjectsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
CommonPrefixes []*CommonPrefix `type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
Contents []*Object `type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
Delimiter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Encoding type used by Amazon S3 to encode object keys in the response.
|
|
EncodingType *string `type:"string" enum:"EncodingType"`
|
|
|
|
// A flag that indicates whether or not Amazon S3 returned all of the results
|
|
// that satisfied the search criteria.
|
|
IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
Marker *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
MaxKeys *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// When response is truncated (the IsTruncated element value in the response
|
|
// is true), you can use the key name in this field as marker in the subsequent
|
|
// request to get next set of objects. Amazon S3 lists objects in alphabetical
|
|
// order Note: This element is returned only if you have delimiter request parameter
|
|
// specified. If response does not include the NextMaker and it is truncated,
|
|
// you can use the value of the last Key in the response as the marker in the
|
|
// subsequent request to get the next set of object keys.
|
|
NextMarker *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListObjectsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListObjectsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCommonPrefixes sets the CommonPrefixes field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsOutput) SetCommonPrefixes(v []*CommonPrefix) *ListObjectsOutput {
|
|
s.CommonPrefixes = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContents sets the Contents field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsOutput) SetContents(v []*Object) *ListObjectsOutput {
|
|
s.Contents = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDelimiter sets the Delimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsOutput) SetDelimiter(v string) *ListObjectsOutput {
|
|
s.Delimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncodingType sets the EncodingType field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsOutput) SetEncodingType(v string) *ListObjectsOutput {
|
|
s.EncodingType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListObjectsOutput {
|
|
s.IsTruncated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *ListObjectsOutput {
|
|
s.Marker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxKeys sets the MaxKeys field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsOutput) SetMaxKeys(v int64) *ListObjectsOutput {
|
|
s.MaxKeys = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsOutput) SetName(v string) *ListObjectsOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextMarker sets the NextMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsOutput) SetNextMarker(v string) *ListObjectsOutput {
|
|
s.NextMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsOutput) SetPrefix(v string) *ListObjectsOutput {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListObjectsV2Input struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the bucket to list.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// ContinuationToken indicates Amazon S3 that the list is being continued on
|
|
// this bucket with a token. ContinuationToken is obfuscated and is not a real
|
|
// key
|
|
ContinuationToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"continuation-token" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A delimiter is a character you use to group keys.
|
|
Delimiter *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"delimiter" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Encoding type used by Amazon S3 to encode object keys in the response.
|
|
EncodingType *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"encoding-type" type:"string" enum:"EncodingType"`
|
|
|
|
// The owner field is not present in listV2 by default, if you want to return
|
|
// owner field with each key in the result then set the fetch owner field to
|
|
// true
|
|
FetchOwner *bool `location:"querystring" locationName:"fetch-owner" type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the maximum number of keys returned in the response. The response might
|
|
// contain fewer keys but will never contain more.
|
|
MaxKeys *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"max-keys" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Limits the response to keys that begin with the specified prefix.
|
|
Prefix *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"prefix" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// list objects request in V2 style. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter
|
|
// in their requests.
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// StartAfter is where you want Amazon S3 to start listing from. Amazon S3 starts
|
|
// listing after this specified key. StartAfter can be any key in the bucket
|
|
StartAfter *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"start-after" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListObjectsV2Input) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListObjectsV2Input) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Input) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListObjectsV2Input"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Input) SetBucket(v string) *ListObjectsV2Input {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Input) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContinuationToken sets the ContinuationToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Input) SetContinuationToken(v string) *ListObjectsV2Input {
|
|
s.ContinuationToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDelimiter sets the Delimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Input) SetDelimiter(v string) *ListObjectsV2Input {
|
|
s.Delimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncodingType sets the EncodingType field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Input) SetEncodingType(v string) *ListObjectsV2Input {
|
|
s.EncodingType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFetchOwner sets the FetchOwner field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Input) SetFetchOwner(v bool) *ListObjectsV2Input {
|
|
s.FetchOwner = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxKeys sets the MaxKeys field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Input) SetMaxKeys(v int64) *ListObjectsV2Input {
|
|
s.MaxKeys = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Input) SetPrefix(v string) *ListObjectsV2Input {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Input) SetRequestPayer(v string) *ListObjectsV2Input {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStartAfter sets the StartAfter field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Input) SetStartAfter(v string) *ListObjectsV2Input {
|
|
s.StartAfter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListObjectsV2Output struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// CommonPrefixes contains all (if there are any) keys between Prefix and the
|
|
// next occurrence of the string specified by delimiter
|
|
CommonPrefixes []*CommonPrefix `type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Metadata about each object returned.
|
|
Contents []*Object `type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// ContinuationToken indicates Amazon S3 that the list is being continued on
|
|
// this bucket with a token. ContinuationToken is obfuscated and is not a real
|
|
// key
|
|
ContinuationToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A delimiter is a character you use to group keys.
|
|
Delimiter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Encoding type used by Amazon S3 to encode object keys in the response.
|
|
EncodingType *string `type:"string" enum:"EncodingType"`
|
|
|
|
// A flag that indicates whether or not Amazon S3 returned all of the results
|
|
// that satisfied the search criteria.
|
|
IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// KeyCount is the number of keys returned with this request. KeyCount will
|
|
// always be less than equals to MaxKeys field. Say you ask for 50 keys, your
|
|
// result will include less than equals 50 keys
|
|
KeyCount *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the maximum number of keys returned in the response. The response might
|
|
// contain fewer keys but will never contain more.
|
|
MaxKeys *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the bucket to list.
|
|
Name *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// NextContinuationToken is sent when isTruncated is true which means there
|
|
// are more keys in the bucket that can be listed. The next list requests to
|
|
// Amazon S3 can be continued with this NextContinuationToken. NextContinuationToken
|
|
// is obfuscated and is not a real key
|
|
NextContinuationToken *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Limits the response to keys that begin with the specified prefix.
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// StartAfter is where you want Amazon S3 to start listing from. Amazon S3 starts
|
|
// listing after this specified key. StartAfter can be any key in the bucket
|
|
StartAfter *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListObjectsV2Output) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListObjectsV2Output) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCommonPrefixes sets the CommonPrefixes field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Output) SetCommonPrefixes(v []*CommonPrefix) *ListObjectsV2Output {
|
|
s.CommonPrefixes = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContents sets the Contents field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Output) SetContents(v []*Object) *ListObjectsV2Output {
|
|
s.Contents = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContinuationToken sets the ContinuationToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Output) SetContinuationToken(v string) *ListObjectsV2Output {
|
|
s.ContinuationToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDelimiter sets the Delimiter field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Output) SetDelimiter(v string) *ListObjectsV2Output {
|
|
s.Delimiter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncodingType sets the EncodingType field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Output) SetEncodingType(v string) *ListObjectsV2Output {
|
|
s.EncodingType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Output) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListObjectsV2Output {
|
|
s.IsTruncated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKeyCount sets the KeyCount field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Output) SetKeyCount(v int64) *ListObjectsV2Output {
|
|
s.KeyCount = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxKeys sets the MaxKeys field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Output) SetMaxKeys(v int64) *ListObjectsV2Output {
|
|
s.MaxKeys = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Output) SetName(v string) *ListObjectsV2Output {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextContinuationToken sets the NextContinuationToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Output) SetNextContinuationToken(v string) *ListObjectsV2Output {
|
|
s.NextContinuationToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Output) SetPrefix(v string) *ListObjectsV2Output {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStartAfter sets the StartAfter field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListObjectsV2Output) SetStartAfter(v string) *ListObjectsV2Output {
|
|
s.StartAfter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListPartsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the maximum number of parts to return.
|
|
MaxParts *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"max-parts" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the part after which listing should begin. Only parts with higher
|
|
// part numbers will be listed.
|
|
PartNumberMarker *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"part-number-marker" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// Upload ID identifying the multipart upload whose parts are being listed.
|
|
//
|
|
// UploadId is a required field
|
|
UploadId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"uploadId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListPartsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListPartsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListPartsInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.UploadId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UploadId"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsInput) SetBucket(v string) *ListPartsInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *ListPartsInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsInput) SetKey(v string) *ListPartsInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxParts sets the MaxParts field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsInput) SetMaxParts(v int64) *ListPartsInput {
|
|
s.MaxParts = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartNumberMarker sets the PartNumberMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsInput) SetPartNumberMarker(v int64) *ListPartsInput {
|
|
s.PartNumberMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *ListPartsInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUploadId sets the UploadId field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsInput) SetUploadId(v string) *ListPartsInput {
|
|
s.UploadId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListPartsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Date when multipart upload will become eligible for abort operation by lifecycle.
|
|
AbortDate *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-abort-date" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Id of the lifecycle rule that makes a multipart upload eligible for abort
|
|
// operation.
|
|
AbortRuleId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-abort-rule-id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the bucket to which the multipart upload was initiated.
|
|
Bucket *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Identifies who initiated the multipart upload.
|
|
Initiator *Initiator `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether the returned list of parts is truncated.
|
|
IsTruncated *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// Object key for which the multipart upload was initiated.
|
|
Key *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Maximum number of parts that were allowed in the response.
|
|
MaxParts *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When a list is truncated, this element specifies the last part in the list,
|
|
// as well as the value to use for the part-number-marker request parameter
|
|
// in a subsequent request.
|
|
NextPartNumberMarker *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
Owner *Owner `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Part number after which listing begins.
|
|
PartNumberMarker *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
Parts []*Part `locationName:"Part" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
|
|
// The class of storage used to store the object.
|
|
StorageClass *string `type:"string" enum:"StorageClass"`
|
|
|
|
// Upload ID identifying the multipart upload whose parts are being listed.
|
|
UploadId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListPartsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListPartsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAbortDate sets the AbortDate field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetAbortDate(v time.Time) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.AbortDate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAbortRuleId sets the AbortRuleId field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetAbortRuleId(v string) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.AbortRuleId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetBucket(v string) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInitiator sets the Initiator field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetInitiator(v *Initiator) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.Initiator = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIsTruncated sets the IsTruncated field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetIsTruncated(v bool) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.IsTruncated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetKey(v string) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxParts sets the MaxParts field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetMaxParts(v int64) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.MaxParts = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextPartNumberMarker sets the NextPartNumberMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetNextPartNumberMarker(v int64) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.NextPartNumberMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwner sets the Owner field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetOwner(v *Owner) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.Owner = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartNumberMarker sets the PartNumberMarker field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetPartNumberMarker(v int64) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.PartNumberMarker = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParts sets the Parts field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetParts(v []*Part) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.Parts = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClass sets the StorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetStorageClass(v string) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.StorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUploadId sets the UploadId field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListPartsOutput) SetUploadId(v string) *ListPartsOutput {
|
|
s.UploadId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Describes an S3 location that will receive the results of the restore request.
|
|
type Location struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of grants that control access to the staged results.
|
|
AccessControlList []*Grant `locationNameList:"Grant" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket where the restore results will be placed.
|
|
//
|
|
// BucketName is a required field
|
|
BucketName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The canned ACL to apply to the restore results.
|
|
CannedACL *string `type:"string" enum:"ObjectCannedACL"`
|
|
|
|
// Describes the server-side encryption that will be applied to the restore
|
|
// results.
|
|
Encryption *Encryption `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The prefix that is prepended to the restore results for this request.
|
|
//
|
|
// Prefix is a required field
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The class of storage used to store the restore results.
|
|
StorageClass *string `type:"string" enum:"StorageClass"`
|
|
|
|
// The tag-set that is applied to the restore results.
|
|
Tagging *Tagging `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of metadata to store with the restore results in S3.
|
|
UserMetadata []*MetadataEntry `locationNameList:"MetadataEntry" type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Location) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Location) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Location) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Location"}
|
|
if s.BucketName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("BucketName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Prefix == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Prefix"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.AccessControlList != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.AccessControlList {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "AccessControlList", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Encryption != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Encryption.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Encryption", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Tagging != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Tagging.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Tagging", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAccessControlList sets the AccessControlList field's value.
|
|
func (s *Location) SetAccessControlList(v []*Grant) *Location {
|
|
s.AccessControlList = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucketName sets the BucketName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Location) SetBucketName(v string) *Location {
|
|
s.BucketName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCannedACL sets the CannedACL field's value.
|
|
func (s *Location) SetCannedACL(v string) *Location {
|
|
s.CannedACL = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncryption sets the Encryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *Location) SetEncryption(v *Encryption) *Location {
|
|
s.Encryption = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *Location) SetPrefix(v string) *Location {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClass sets the StorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *Location) SetStorageClass(v string) *Location {
|
|
s.StorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTagging sets the Tagging field's value.
|
|
func (s *Location) SetTagging(v *Tagging) *Location {
|
|
s.Tagging = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUserMetadata sets the UserMetadata field's value.
|
|
func (s *Location) SetUserMetadata(v []*MetadataEntry) *Location {
|
|
s.UserMetadata = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Container for logging information. Presence of this element indicates that
|
|
// logging is enabled. Parameters TargetBucket and TargetPrefix are required
|
|
// in this case.
|
|
type LoggingEnabled struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the bucket where you want Amazon S3 to store server access logs.
|
|
// You can have your logs delivered to any bucket that you own, including the
|
|
// same bucket that is being logged. You can also configure multiple buckets
|
|
// to deliver their logs to the same target bucket. In this case you should
|
|
// choose a different TargetPrefix for each source bucket so that the delivered
|
|
// log files can be distinguished by key.
|
|
//
|
|
// TargetBucket is a required field
|
|
TargetBucket *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
TargetGrants []*TargetGrant `locationNameList:"Grant" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// This element lets you specify a prefix for the keys that the log files will
|
|
// be stored under.
|
|
//
|
|
// TargetPrefix is a required field
|
|
TargetPrefix *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LoggingEnabled) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s LoggingEnabled) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *LoggingEnabled) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "LoggingEnabled"}
|
|
if s.TargetBucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetBucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TargetPrefix == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetPrefix"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TargetGrants != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.TargetGrants {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "TargetGrants", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTargetBucket sets the TargetBucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *LoggingEnabled) SetTargetBucket(v string) *LoggingEnabled {
|
|
s.TargetBucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTargetGrants sets the TargetGrants field's value.
|
|
func (s *LoggingEnabled) SetTargetGrants(v []*TargetGrant) *LoggingEnabled {
|
|
s.TargetGrants = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTargetPrefix sets the TargetPrefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *LoggingEnabled) SetTargetPrefix(v string) *LoggingEnabled {
|
|
s.TargetPrefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A metadata key-value pair to store with an object.
|
|
type MetadataEntry struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Value *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MetadataEntry) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MetadataEntry) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *MetadataEntry) SetName(v string) *MetadataEntry {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetValue sets the Value field's value.
|
|
func (s *MetadataEntry) SetValue(v string) *MetadataEntry {
|
|
s.Value = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type MetricsAndOperator struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The prefix used when evaluating an AND predicate.
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The list of tags used when evaluating an AND predicate.
|
|
Tags []*Tag `locationName:"Tag" locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MetricsAndOperator) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MetricsAndOperator) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *MetricsAndOperator) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "MetricsAndOperator"}
|
|
if s.Tags != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Tags {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Tags", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *MetricsAndOperator) SetPrefix(v string) *MetricsAndOperator {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
|
|
func (s *MetricsAndOperator) SetTags(v []*Tag) *MetricsAndOperator {
|
|
s.Tags = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type MetricsConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a metrics configuration filter. The metrics configuration will
|
|
// only include objects that meet the filter's criteria. A filter must be a
|
|
// prefix, a tag, or a conjunction (MetricsAndOperator).
|
|
Filter *MetricsFilter `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID used to identify the metrics configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Id is a required field
|
|
Id *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MetricsConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MetricsConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *MetricsConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "MetricsConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.Id == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Filter != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Filter.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Filter", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilter sets the Filter field's value.
|
|
func (s *MetricsConfiguration) SetFilter(v *MetricsFilter) *MetricsConfiguration {
|
|
s.Filter = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *MetricsConfiguration) SetId(v string) *MetricsConfiguration {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type MetricsFilter struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A conjunction (logical AND) of predicates, which is used in evaluating a
|
|
// metrics filter. The operator must have at least two predicates, and an object
|
|
// must match all of the predicates in order for the filter to apply.
|
|
And *MetricsAndOperator `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The prefix used when evaluating a metrics filter.
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The tag used when evaluating a metrics filter.
|
|
Tag *Tag `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MetricsFilter) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MetricsFilter) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *MetricsFilter) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "MetricsFilter"}
|
|
if s.And != nil {
|
|
if err := s.And.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("And", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Tag != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Tag.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Tag", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAnd sets the And field's value.
|
|
func (s *MetricsFilter) SetAnd(v *MetricsAndOperator) *MetricsFilter {
|
|
s.And = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *MetricsFilter) SetPrefix(v string) *MetricsFilter {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTag sets the Tag field's value.
|
|
func (s *MetricsFilter) SetTag(v *Tag) *MetricsFilter {
|
|
s.Tag = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type MultipartUpload struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Date and time at which the multipart upload was initiated.
|
|
Initiated *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Identifies who initiated the multipart upload.
|
|
Initiator *Initiator `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Key of the object for which the multipart upload was initiated.
|
|
Key *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Owner *Owner `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The class of storage used to store the object.
|
|
StorageClass *string `type:"string" enum:"StorageClass"`
|
|
|
|
// Upload ID that identifies the multipart upload.
|
|
UploadId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MultipartUpload) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MultipartUpload) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInitiated sets the Initiated field's value.
|
|
func (s *MultipartUpload) SetInitiated(v time.Time) *MultipartUpload {
|
|
s.Initiated = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInitiator sets the Initiator field's value.
|
|
func (s *MultipartUpload) SetInitiator(v *Initiator) *MultipartUpload {
|
|
s.Initiator = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *MultipartUpload) SetKey(v string) *MultipartUpload {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwner sets the Owner field's value.
|
|
func (s *MultipartUpload) SetOwner(v *Owner) *MultipartUpload {
|
|
s.Owner = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClass sets the StorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *MultipartUpload) SetStorageClass(v string) *MultipartUpload {
|
|
s.StorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUploadId sets the UploadId field's value.
|
|
func (s *MultipartUpload) SetUploadId(v string) *MultipartUpload {
|
|
s.UploadId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies when noncurrent object versions expire. Upon expiration, Amazon
|
|
// S3 permanently deletes the noncurrent object versions. You set this lifecycle
|
|
// configuration action on a bucket that has versioning enabled (or suspended)
|
|
// to request that Amazon S3 delete noncurrent object versions at a specific
|
|
// period in the object's lifetime.
|
|
type NoncurrentVersionExpiration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the number of days an object is noncurrent before Amazon S3 can
|
|
// perform the associated action. For information about the noncurrent days
|
|
// calculations, see How Amazon S3 Calculates When an Object Became Noncurrent
|
|
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/s3-access-control.html)
|
|
// in the Amazon Simple Storage Service Developer Guide.
|
|
NoncurrentDays *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NoncurrentVersionExpiration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NoncurrentVersionExpiration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNoncurrentDays sets the NoncurrentDays field's value.
|
|
func (s *NoncurrentVersionExpiration) SetNoncurrentDays(v int64) *NoncurrentVersionExpiration {
|
|
s.NoncurrentDays = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Container for the transition rule that describes when noncurrent objects
|
|
// transition to the STANDARD_IA, ONEZONE_IA, INTELLIGENT_TIERING, GLACIER or
|
|
// DEEP_ARCHIVE storage class. If your bucket is versioning-enabled (or versioning
|
|
// is suspended), you can set this action to request that Amazon S3 transition
|
|
// noncurrent object versions to the STANDARD_IA, ONEZONE_IA, INTELLIGENT_TIERING,
|
|
// GLACIER or DEEP_ARCHIVE storage class at a specific period in the object's
|
|
// lifetime.
|
|
type NoncurrentVersionTransition struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the number of days an object is noncurrent before Amazon S3 can
|
|
// perform the associated action. For information about the noncurrent days
|
|
// calculations, see How Amazon S3 Calculates When an Object Became Noncurrent
|
|
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/s3-access-control.html)
|
|
// in the Amazon Simple Storage Service Developer Guide.
|
|
NoncurrentDays *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The class of storage used to store the object.
|
|
StorageClass *string `type:"string" enum:"TransitionStorageClass"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NoncurrentVersionTransition) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NoncurrentVersionTransition) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNoncurrentDays sets the NoncurrentDays field's value.
|
|
func (s *NoncurrentVersionTransition) SetNoncurrentDays(v int64) *NoncurrentVersionTransition {
|
|
s.NoncurrentDays = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClass sets the StorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *NoncurrentVersionTransition) SetStorageClass(v string) *NoncurrentVersionTransition {
|
|
s.StorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for specifying the notification configuration of the bucket.
|
|
// If this element is empty, notifications are turned off for the bucket.
|
|
type NotificationConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
LambdaFunctionConfigurations []*LambdaFunctionConfiguration `locationName:"CloudFunctionConfiguration" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
QueueConfigurations []*QueueConfiguration `locationName:"QueueConfiguration" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
TopicConfigurations []*TopicConfiguration `locationName:"TopicConfiguration" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NotificationConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NotificationConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *NotificationConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "NotificationConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.LambdaFunctionConfigurations != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.LambdaFunctionConfigurations {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "LambdaFunctionConfigurations", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.QueueConfigurations != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.QueueConfigurations {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "QueueConfigurations", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TopicConfigurations != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.TopicConfigurations {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "TopicConfigurations", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLambdaFunctionConfigurations sets the LambdaFunctionConfigurations field's value.
|
|
func (s *NotificationConfiguration) SetLambdaFunctionConfigurations(v []*LambdaFunctionConfiguration) *NotificationConfiguration {
|
|
s.LambdaFunctionConfigurations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetQueueConfigurations sets the QueueConfigurations field's value.
|
|
func (s *NotificationConfiguration) SetQueueConfigurations(v []*QueueConfiguration) *NotificationConfiguration {
|
|
s.QueueConfigurations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTopicConfigurations sets the TopicConfigurations field's value.
|
|
func (s *NotificationConfiguration) SetTopicConfigurations(v []*TopicConfiguration) *NotificationConfiguration {
|
|
s.TopicConfigurations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type NotificationConfigurationDeprecated struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
CloudFunctionConfiguration *CloudFunctionConfiguration `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
QueueConfiguration *QueueConfigurationDeprecated `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
TopicConfiguration *TopicConfigurationDeprecated `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NotificationConfigurationDeprecated) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NotificationConfigurationDeprecated) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCloudFunctionConfiguration sets the CloudFunctionConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *NotificationConfigurationDeprecated) SetCloudFunctionConfiguration(v *CloudFunctionConfiguration) *NotificationConfigurationDeprecated {
|
|
s.CloudFunctionConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetQueueConfiguration sets the QueueConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *NotificationConfigurationDeprecated) SetQueueConfiguration(v *QueueConfigurationDeprecated) *NotificationConfigurationDeprecated {
|
|
s.QueueConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTopicConfiguration sets the TopicConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *NotificationConfigurationDeprecated) SetTopicConfiguration(v *TopicConfigurationDeprecated) *NotificationConfigurationDeprecated {
|
|
s.TopicConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for object key name filtering rules. For information about key
|
|
// name filtering, see Configuring Event Notifications (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/NotificationHowTo.html)
|
|
// in the Amazon Simple Storage Service Developer Guide.
|
|
type NotificationConfigurationFilter struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for object key name prefix and suffix filtering rules.
|
|
Key *KeyFilter `locationName:"S3Key" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NotificationConfigurationFilter) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NotificationConfigurationFilter) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *NotificationConfigurationFilter) SetKey(v *KeyFilter) *NotificationConfigurationFilter {
|
|
s.Key = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Object struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
ETag *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Key *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
LastModified *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
Owner *Owner `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Size *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The class of storage used to store the object.
|
|
StorageClass *string `type:"string" enum:"ObjectStorageClass"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Object) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Object) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetETag sets the ETag field's value.
|
|
func (s *Object) SetETag(v string) *Object {
|
|
s.ETag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *Object) SetKey(v string) *Object {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastModified sets the LastModified field's value.
|
|
func (s *Object) SetLastModified(v time.Time) *Object {
|
|
s.LastModified = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwner sets the Owner field's value.
|
|
func (s *Object) SetOwner(v *Owner) *Object {
|
|
s.Owner = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSize sets the Size field's value.
|
|
func (s *Object) SetSize(v int64) *Object {
|
|
s.Size = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClass sets the StorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *Object) SetStorageClass(v string) *Object {
|
|
s.StorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ObjectIdentifier struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Key name of the object to delete.
|
|
//
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// VersionId for the specific version of the object to delete.
|
|
VersionId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ObjectIdentifier) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ObjectIdentifier) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ObjectIdentifier) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ObjectIdentifier"}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectIdentifier) SetKey(v string) *ObjectIdentifier {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectIdentifier) SetVersionId(v string) *ObjectIdentifier {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The container element for Object Lock configuration parameters.
|
|
type ObjectLockConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether this bucket has an Object Lock configuration enabled.
|
|
ObjectLockEnabled *string `type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockEnabled"`
|
|
|
|
// The Object Lock rule in place for the specified object.
|
|
Rule *ObjectLockRule `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ObjectLockConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ObjectLockConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockEnabled sets the ObjectLockEnabled field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectLockConfiguration) SetObjectLockEnabled(v string) *ObjectLockConfiguration {
|
|
s.ObjectLockEnabled = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRule sets the Rule field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectLockConfiguration) SetRule(v *ObjectLockRule) *ObjectLockConfiguration {
|
|
s.Rule = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A Legal Hold configuration for an object.
|
|
type ObjectLockLegalHold struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether the specified object has a Legal Hold in place.
|
|
Status *string `type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ObjectLockLegalHold) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ObjectLockLegalHold) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectLockLegalHold) SetStatus(v string) *ObjectLockLegalHold {
|
|
s.Status = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A Retention configuration for an object.
|
|
type ObjectLockRetention struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates the Retention mode for the specified object.
|
|
Mode *string `type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockRetentionMode"`
|
|
|
|
// The date on which this Object Lock Retention will expire.
|
|
RetainUntilDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ObjectLockRetention) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ObjectLockRetention) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMode sets the Mode field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectLockRetention) SetMode(v string) *ObjectLockRetention {
|
|
s.Mode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRetainUntilDate sets the RetainUntilDate field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectLockRetention) SetRetainUntilDate(v time.Time) *ObjectLockRetention {
|
|
s.RetainUntilDate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The container element for an Object Lock rule.
|
|
type ObjectLockRule struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The default retention period that you want to apply to new objects placed
|
|
// in the specified bucket.
|
|
DefaultRetention *DefaultRetention `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ObjectLockRule) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ObjectLockRule) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDefaultRetention sets the DefaultRetention field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectLockRule) SetDefaultRetention(v *DefaultRetention) *ObjectLockRule {
|
|
s.DefaultRetention = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ObjectVersion struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
ETag *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether the object is (true) or is not (false) the latest version
|
|
// of an object.
|
|
IsLatest *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The object key.
|
|
Key *string `min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Date and time the object was last modified.
|
|
LastModified *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
Owner *Owner `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Size in bytes of the object.
|
|
Size *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The class of storage used to store the object.
|
|
StorageClass *string `type:"string" enum:"ObjectVersionStorageClass"`
|
|
|
|
// Version ID of an object.
|
|
VersionId *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ObjectVersion) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ObjectVersion) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetETag sets the ETag field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectVersion) SetETag(v string) *ObjectVersion {
|
|
s.ETag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIsLatest sets the IsLatest field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectVersion) SetIsLatest(v bool) *ObjectVersion {
|
|
s.IsLatest = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectVersion) SetKey(v string) *ObjectVersion {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastModified sets the LastModified field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectVersion) SetLastModified(v time.Time) *ObjectVersion {
|
|
s.LastModified = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOwner sets the Owner field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectVersion) SetOwner(v *Owner) *ObjectVersion {
|
|
s.Owner = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSize sets the Size field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectVersion) SetSize(v int64) *ObjectVersion {
|
|
s.Size = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClass sets the StorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectVersion) SetStorageClass(v string) *ObjectVersion {
|
|
s.StorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *ObjectVersion) SetVersionId(v string) *ObjectVersion {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Describes the location where the restore job's output is stored.
|
|
type OutputLocation struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Describes an S3 location that will receive the results of the restore request.
|
|
S3 *Location `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputLocation) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputLocation) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *OutputLocation) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "OutputLocation"}
|
|
if s.S3 != nil {
|
|
if err := s.S3.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("S3", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetS3 sets the S3 field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputLocation) SetS3(v *Location) *OutputLocation {
|
|
s.S3 = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Describes how results of the Select job are serialized.
|
|
type OutputSerialization struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Describes the serialization of CSV-encoded Select results.
|
|
CSV *CSVOutput `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies JSON as request's output serialization format.
|
|
JSON *JSONOutput `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputSerialization) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputSerialization) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCSV sets the CSV field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputSerialization) SetCSV(v *CSVOutput) *OutputSerialization {
|
|
s.CSV = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetJSON sets the JSON field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputSerialization) SetJSON(v *JSONOutput) *OutputSerialization {
|
|
s.JSON = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Owner struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
DisplayName *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
ID *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Owner) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Owner) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDisplayName sets the DisplayName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Owner) SetDisplayName(v string) *Owner {
|
|
s.DisplayName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetID sets the ID field's value.
|
|
func (s *Owner) SetID(v string) *Owner {
|
|
s.ID = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ParquetInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ParquetInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ParquetInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Part struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Entity tag returned when the part was uploaded.
|
|
ETag *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Date and time at which the part was uploaded.
|
|
LastModified *time.Time `type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Part number identifying the part. This is a positive integer between 1 and
|
|
// 10,000.
|
|
PartNumber *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Size in bytes of the uploaded part data.
|
|
Size *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Part) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Part) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetETag sets the ETag field's value.
|
|
func (s *Part) SetETag(v string) *Part {
|
|
s.ETag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLastModified sets the LastModified field's value.
|
|
func (s *Part) SetLastModified(v time.Time) *Part {
|
|
s.LastModified = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartNumber sets the PartNumber field's value.
|
|
func (s *Part) SetPartNumber(v int64) *Part {
|
|
s.PartNumber = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSize sets the Size field's value.
|
|
func (s *Part) SetSize(v int64) *Part {
|
|
s.Size = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The container element for a bucket's policy status.
|
|
type PolicyStatus struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The policy status for this bucket. TRUE indicates that this bucket is public.
|
|
// FALSE indicates that the bucket is not public.
|
|
IsPublic *bool `locationName:"IsPublic" type:"boolean"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PolicyStatus) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PolicyStatus) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIsPublic sets the IsPublic field's value.
|
|
func (s *PolicyStatus) SetIsPublic(v bool) *PolicyStatus {
|
|
s.IsPublic = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Progress struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The current number of uncompressed object bytes processed.
|
|
BytesProcessed *int64 `type:"long"`
|
|
|
|
// The current number of bytes of records payload data returned.
|
|
BytesReturned *int64 `type:"long"`
|
|
|
|
// The current number of object bytes scanned.
|
|
BytesScanned *int64 `type:"long"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Progress) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Progress) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBytesProcessed sets the BytesProcessed field's value.
|
|
func (s *Progress) SetBytesProcessed(v int64) *Progress {
|
|
s.BytesProcessed = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBytesReturned sets the BytesReturned field's value.
|
|
func (s *Progress) SetBytesReturned(v int64) *Progress {
|
|
s.BytesReturned = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBytesScanned sets the BytesScanned field's value.
|
|
func (s *Progress) SetBytesScanned(v int64) *Progress {
|
|
s.BytesScanned = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ProgressEvent struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `locationName:"ProgressEvent" type:"structure" payload:"Details"`
|
|
|
|
// The Progress event details.
|
|
Details *Progress `locationName:"Details" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ProgressEvent) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ProgressEvent) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDetails sets the Details field's value.
|
|
func (s *ProgressEvent) SetDetails(v *Progress) *ProgressEvent {
|
|
s.Details = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The ProgressEvent is and event in the SelectObjectContentEventStream group of events.
|
|
func (s *ProgressEvent) eventSelectObjectContentEventStream() {}
|
|
|
|
// UnmarshalEvent unmarshals the EventStream Message into the ProgressEvent value.
|
|
// This method is only used internally within the SDK's EventStream handling.
|
|
func (s *ProgressEvent) UnmarshalEvent(
|
|
payloadUnmarshaler protocol.PayloadUnmarshaler,
|
|
msg eventstream.Message,
|
|
) error {
|
|
if err := payloadUnmarshaler.UnmarshalPayload(
|
|
bytes.NewReader(msg.Payload), s,
|
|
); err != nil {
|
|
return err
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PublicAccessBlockConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether Amazon S3 should block public access control lists (ACLs)
|
|
// for this bucket and objects in this bucket. Setting this element to TRUE
|
|
// causes the following behavior:
|
|
//
|
|
// * PUT Bucket acl and PUT Object acl calls fail if the specified ACL is
|
|
// public.
|
|
//
|
|
// * PUT Object calls fail if the request includes a public ACL.
|
|
//
|
|
// Enabling this setting doesn't affect existing policies or ACLs.
|
|
BlockPublicAcls *bool `locationName:"BlockPublicAcls" type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether Amazon S3 should block public bucket policies for this
|
|
// bucket. Setting this element to TRUE causes Amazon S3 to reject calls to
|
|
// PUT Bucket policy if the specified bucket policy allows public access.
|
|
//
|
|
// Enabling this setting doesn't affect existing bucket policies.
|
|
BlockPublicPolicy *bool `locationName:"BlockPublicPolicy" type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether Amazon S3 should ignore public ACLs for this bucket and
|
|
// objects in this bucket. Setting this element to TRUE causes Amazon S3 to
|
|
// ignore all public ACLs on this bucket and objects in this bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Enabling this setting doesn't affect the persistence of any existing ACLs
|
|
// and doesn't prevent new public ACLs from being set.
|
|
IgnorePublicAcls *bool `locationName:"IgnorePublicAcls" type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether Amazon S3 should restrict public bucket policies for this
|
|
// bucket. Setting this element to TRUE restricts access to this bucket to only
|
|
// AWS services and authorized users within this account if the bucket has a
|
|
// public policy.
|
|
//
|
|
// Enabling this setting doesn't affect previously stored bucket policies, except
|
|
// that public and cross-account access within any public bucket policy, including
|
|
// non-public delegation to specific accounts, is blocked.
|
|
RestrictPublicBuckets *bool `locationName:"RestrictPublicBuckets" type:"boolean"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PublicAccessBlockConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PublicAccessBlockConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBlockPublicAcls sets the BlockPublicAcls field's value.
|
|
func (s *PublicAccessBlockConfiguration) SetBlockPublicAcls(v bool) *PublicAccessBlockConfiguration {
|
|
s.BlockPublicAcls = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBlockPublicPolicy sets the BlockPublicPolicy field's value.
|
|
func (s *PublicAccessBlockConfiguration) SetBlockPublicPolicy(v bool) *PublicAccessBlockConfiguration {
|
|
s.BlockPublicPolicy = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIgnorePublicAcls sets the IgnorePublicAcls field's value.
|
|
func (s *PublicAccessBlockConfiguration) SetIgnorePublicAcls(v bool) *PublicAccessBlockConfiguration {
|
|
s.IgnorePublicAcls = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRestrictPublicBuckets sets the RestrictPublicBuckets field's value.
|
|
func (s *PublicAccessBlockConfiguration) SetRestrictPublicBuckets(v bool) *PublicAccessBlockConfiguration {
|
|
s.RestrictPublicBuckets = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"AccelerateConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the Accelerate Configuration you want to set for the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// AccelerateConfiguration is a required field
|
|
AccelerateConfiguration *AccelerateConfiguration `locationName:"AccelerateConfiguration" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the bucket for which the accelerate configuration is set.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.AccelerateConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AccelerateConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAccelerateConfiguration sets the AccelerateConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) SetAccelerateConfiguration(v *AccelerateConfiguration) *PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.AccelerateConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketAclInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"AccessControlPolicy"`
|
|
|
|
// The canned ACL to apply to the bucket.
|
|
ACL *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-acl" type:"string" enum:"BucketCannedACL"`
|
|
|
|
AccessControlPolicy *AccessControlPolicy `locationName:"AccessControlPolicy" type:"structure" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee the read, write, read ACP, and write ACP permissions on the
|
|
// bucket.
|
|
GrantFullControl *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-full-control" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to list the objects in the bucket.
|
|
GrantRead *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-read" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to read the bucket ACL.
|
|
GrantReadACP *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-read-acp" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to create, overwrite, and delete any object in the bucket.
|
|
GrantWrite *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-write" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to write the ACL for the applicable bucket.
|
|
GrantWriteACP *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-write-acp" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketAclInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketAclInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAclInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketAclInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.AccessControlPolicy != nil {
|
|
if err := s.AccessControlPolicy.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("AccessControlPolicy", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetACL sets the ACL field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAclInput) SetACL(v string) *PutBucketAclInput {
|
|
s.ACL = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAccessControlPolicy sets the AccessControlPolicy field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAclInput) SetAccessControlPolicy(v *AccessControlPolicy) *PutBucketAclInput {
|
|
s.AccessControlPolicy = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAclInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketAclInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAclInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantFullControl sets the GrantFullControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAclInput) SetGrantFullControl(v string) *PutBucketAclInput {
|
|
s.GrantFullControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantRead sets the GrantRead field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAclInput) SetGrantRead(v string) *PutBucketAclInput {
|
|
s.GrantRead = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantReadACP sets the GrantReadACP field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAclInput) SetGrantReadACP(v string) *PutBucketAclInput {
|
|
s.GrantReadACP = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantWrite sets the GrantWrite field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAclInput) SetGrantWrite(v string) *PutBucketAclInput {
|
|
s.GrantWrite = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantWriteACP sets the GrantWriteACP field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAclInput) SetGrantWriteACP(v string) *PutBucketAclInput {
|
|
s.GrantWriteACP = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketAclOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketAclOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketAclOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"AnalyticsConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// The configuration and any analyses for the analytics filter.
|
|
//
|
|
// AnalyticsConfiguration is a required field
|
|
AnalyticsConfiguration *AnalyticsConfiguration `locationName:"AnalyticsConfiguration" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket to which an analytics configuration is stored.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The identifier used to represent an analytics configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Id is a required field
|
|
Id *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"id" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.AnalyticsConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AnalyticsConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Id == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.AnalyticsConfiguration != nil {
|
|
if err := s.AnalyticsConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("AnalyticsConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAnalyticsConfiguration sets the AnalyticsConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) SetAnalyticsConfiguration(v *AnalyticsConfiguration) *PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.AnalyticsConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput) SetId(v string) *PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketCorsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"CORSConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// CORSConfiguration is a required field
|
|
CORSConfiguration *CORSConfiguration `locationName:"CORSConfiguration" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketCorsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketCorsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketCorsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketCorsInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CORSConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CORSConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CORSConfiguration != nil {
|
|
if err := s.CORSConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("CORSConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketCorsInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketCorsInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketCorsInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCORSConfiguration sets the CORSConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketCorsInput) SetCORSConfiguration(v *CORSConfiguration) *PutBucketCorsInput {
|
|
s.CORSConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketCorsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketCorsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketCorsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketEncryptionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket for which the server-side encryption configuration
|
|
// is set.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Container for server-side encryption configuration rules. Currently S3 supports
|
|
// one rule only.
|
|
//
|
|
// ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration is a required field
|
|
ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration *ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration `locationName:"ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketEncryptionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketEncryptionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketEncryptionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketEncryptionInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration != nil {
|
|
if err := s.ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketEncryptionInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketEncryptionInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketEncryptionInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerSideEncryptionConfiguration sets the ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketEncryptionInput) SetServerSideEncryptionConfiguration(v *ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration) *PutBucketEncryptionInput {
|
|
s.ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketEncryptionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketEncryptionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketEncryptionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"InventoryConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket where the inventory configuration will be stored.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID used to identify the inventory configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Id is a required field
|
|
Id *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"id" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the inventory configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// InventoryConfiguration is a required field
|
|
InventoryConfiguration *InventoryConfiguration `locationName:"InventoryConfiguration" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Id == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InventoryConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InventoryConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InventoryConfiguration != nil {
|
|
if err := s.InventoryConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("InventoryConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) SetId(v string) *PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInventoryConfiguration sets the InventoryConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput) SetInventoryConfiguration(v *InventoryConfiguration) *PutBucketInventoryConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.InventoryConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"LifecycleConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
LifecycleConfiguration *BucketLifecycleConfiguration `locationName:"LifecycleConfiguration" type:"structure" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.LifecycleConfiguration != nil {
|
|
if err := s.LifecycleConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("LifecycleConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLifecycleConfiguration sets the LifecycleConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput) SetLifecycleConfiguration(v *BucketLifecycleConfiguration) *PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.LifecycleConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketLifecycleInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"LifecycleConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
LifecycleConfiguration *LifecycleConfiguration `locationName:"LifecycleConfiguration" type:"structure" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketLifecycleInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketLifecycleInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketLifecycleInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketLifecycleInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.LifecycleConfiguration != nil {
|
|
if err := s.LifecycleConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("LifecycleConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketLifecycleInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketLifecycleInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketLifecycleInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLifecycleConfiguration sets the LifecycleConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketLifecycleInput) SetLifecycleConfiguration(v *LifecycleConfiguration) *PutBucketLifecycleInput {
|
|
s.LifecycleConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketLifecycleOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketLifecycleOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketLifecycleOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketLoggingInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"BucketLoggingStatus"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// BucketLoggingStatus is a required field
|
|
BucketLoggingStatus *BucketLoggingStatus `locationName:"BucketLoggingStatus" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketLoggingInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketLoggingInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketLoggingInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketLoggingInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.BucketLoggingStatus == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("BucketLoggingStatus"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.BucketLoggingStatus != nil {
|
|
if err := s.BucketLoggingStatus.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("BucketLoggingStatus", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketLoggingInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketLoggingInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketLoggingInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucketLoggingStatus sets the BucketLoggingStatus field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketLoggingInput) SetBucketLoggingStatus(v *BucketLoggingStatus) *PutBucketLoggingInput {
|
|
s.BucketLoggingStatus = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketLoggingOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketLoggingOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketLoggingOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"MetricsConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the bucket for which the metrics configuration is set.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID used to identify the metrics configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// Id is a required field
|
|
Id *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"id" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the metrics configuration.
|
|
//
|
|
// MetricsConfiguration is a required field
|
|
MetricsConfiguration *MetricsConfiguration `locationName:"MetricsConfiguration" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Id == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.MetricsConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("MetricsConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.MetricsConfiguration != nil {
|
|
if err := s.MetricsConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("MetricsConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) SetId(v string) *PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMetricsConfiguration sets the MetricsConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput) SetMetricsConfiguration(v *MetricsConfiguration) *PutBucketMetricsConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.MetricsConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"NotificationConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for specifying the notification configuration of the bucket.
|
|
// If this element is empty, notifications are turned off for the bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// NotificationConfiguration is a required field
|
|
NotificationConfiguration *NotificationConfiguration `locationName:"NotificationConfiguration" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NotificationConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("NotificationConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NotificationConfiguration != nil {
|
|
if err := s.NotificationConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("NotificationConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNotificationConfiguration sets the NotificationConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput) SetNotificationConfiguration(v *NotificationConfiguration) *PutBucketNotificationConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.NotificationConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketNotificationConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketNotificationConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketNotificationConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketNotificationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"NotificationConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// NotificationConfiguration is a required field
|
|
NotificationConfiguration *NotificationConfigurationDeprecated `locationName:"NotificationConfiguration" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketNotificationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketNotificationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketNotificationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketNotificationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NotificationConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("NotificationConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketNotificationInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketNotificationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketNotificationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNotificationConfiguration sets the NotificationConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketNotificationInput) SetNotificationConfiguration(v *NotificationConfigurationDeprecated) *PutBucketNotificationInput {
|
|
s.NotificationConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketNotificationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketNotificationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketNotificationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketPolicyInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"Policy"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Set this parameter to true to confirm that you want to remove your permissions
|
|
// to change this bucket policy in the future.
|
|
ConfirmRemoveSelfBucketAccess *bool `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-confirm-remove-self-bucket-access" type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The bucket policy as a JSON document.
|
|
//
|
|
// Policy is a required field
|
|
Policy *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketPolicyInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketPolicyInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketPolicyInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketPolicyInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Policy == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Policy"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketPolicyInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketPolicyInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketPolicyInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConfirmRemoveSelfBucketAccess sets the ConfirmRemoveSelfBucketAccess field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketPolicyInput) SetConfirmRemoveSelfBucketAccess(v bool) *PutBucketPolicyInput {
|
|
s.ConfirmRemoveSelfBucketAccess = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPolicy sets the Policy field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketPolicyInput) SetPolicy(v string) *PutBucketPolicyInput {
|
|
s.Policy = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketPolicyOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketPolicyOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketPolicyOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketReplicationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"ReplicationConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for replication rules. You can add up to 1,000 rules. The maximum
|
|
// size of a replication configuration is 2 MB.
|
|
//
|
|
// ReplicationConfiguration is a required field
|
|
ReplicationConfiguration *ReplicationConfiguration `locationName:"ReplicationConfiguration" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketReplicationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketReplicationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketReplicationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketReplicationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ReplicationConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ReplicationConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ReplicationConfiguration != nil {
|
|
if err := s.ReplicationConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("ReplicationConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketReplicationInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketReplicationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketReplicationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReplicationConfiguration sets the ReplicationConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketReplicationInput) SetReplicationConfiguration(v *ReplicationConfiguration) *PutBucketReplicationInput {
|
|
s.ReplicationConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketReplicationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketReplicationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketReplicationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketRequestPaymentInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"RequestPaymentConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// RequestPaymentConfiguration is a required field
|
|
RequestPaymentConfiguration *RequestPaymentConfiguration `locationName:"RequestPaymentConfiguration" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketRequestPaymentInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketRequestPaymentInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketRequestPaymentInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketRequestPaymentInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RequestPaymentConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RequestPaymentConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RequestPaymentConfiguration != nil {
|
|
if err := s.RequestPaymentConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("RequestPaymentConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketRequestPaymentInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketRequestPaymentInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketRequestPaymentInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPaymentConfiguration sets the RequestPaymentConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketRequestPaymentInput) SetRequestPaymentConfiguration(v *RequestPaymentConfiguration) *PutBucketRequestPaymentInput {
|
|
s.RequestPaymentConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketRequestPaymentOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketRequestPaymentOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketRequestPaymentOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketTaggingInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"Tagging"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Tagging is a required field
|
|
Tagging *Tagging `locationName:"Tagging" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketTaggingInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketTaggingInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketTaggingInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketTaggingInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Tagging == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Tagging"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Tagging != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Tagging.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Tagging", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketTaggingInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketTaggingInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketTaggingInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTagging sets the Tagging field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketTaggingInput) SetTagging(v *Tagging) *PutBucketTaggingInput {
|
|
s.Tagging = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketTaggingOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketTaggingOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketTaggingOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketVersioningInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"VersioningConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The concatenation of the authentication device's serial number, a space,
|
|
// and the value that is displayed on your authentication device.
|
|
MFA *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-mfa" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// VersioningConfiguration is a required field
|
|
VersioningConfiguration *VersioningConfiguration `locationName:"VersioningConfiguration" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketVersioningInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketVersioningInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketVersioningInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketVersioningInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.VersioningConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("VersioningConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketVersioningInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketVersioningInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketVersioningInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMFA sets the MFA field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketVersioningInput) SetMFA(v string) *PutBucketVersioningInput {
|
|
s.MFA = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersioningConfiguration sets the VersioningConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketVersioningInput) SetVersioningConfiguration(v *VersioningConfiguration) *PutBucketVersioningInput {
|
|
s.VersioningConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketVersioningOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketVersioningOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketVersioningOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketWebsiteInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"WebsiteConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// WebsiteConfiguration is a required field
|
|
WebsiteConfiguration *WebsiteConfiguration `locationName:"WebsiteConfiguration" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketWebsiteInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketWebsiteInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketWebsiteInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutBucketWebsiteInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.WebsiteConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("WebsiteConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.WebsiteConfiguration != nil {
|
|
if err := s.WebsiteConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("WebsiteConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketWebsiteInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutBucketWebsiteInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutBucketWebsiteInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWebsiteConfiguration sets the WebsiteConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutBucketWebsiteInput) SetWebsiteConfiguration(v *WebsiteConfiguration) *PutBucketWebsiteInput {
|
|
s.WebsiteConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutBucketWebsiteOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketWebsiteOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutBucketWebsiteOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutObjectAclInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"AccessControlPolicy"`
|
|
|
|
// The canned ACL to apply to the object.
|
|
ACL *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-acl" type:"string" enum:"ObjectCannedACL"`
|
|
|
|
AccessControlPolicy *AccessControlPolicy `locationName:"AccessControlPolicy" type:"structure" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee the read, write, read ACP, and write ACP permissions on the
|
|
// bucket.
|
|
GrantFullControl *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-full-control" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to list the objects in the bucket.
|
|
GrantRead *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-read" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to read the bucket ACL.
|
|
GrantReadACP *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-read-acp" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to create, overwrite, and delete any object in the bucket.
|
|
GrantWrite *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-write" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to write the ACL for the applicable bucket.
|
|
GrantWriteACP *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-write-acp" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// VersionId used to reference a specific version of the object.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"versionId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectAclInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectAclInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutObjectAclInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.AccessControlPolicy != nil {
|
|
if err := s.AccessControlPolicy.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("AccessControlPolicy", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetACL sets the ACL field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclInput) SetACL(v string) *PutObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.ACL = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAccessControlPolicy sets the AccessControlPolicy field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclInput) SetAccessControlPolicy(v *AccessControlPolicy) *PutObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.AccessControlPolicy = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantFullControl sets the GrantFullControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclInput) SetGrantFullControl(v string) *PutObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.GrantFullControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantRead sets the GrantRead field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclInput) SetGrantRead(v string) *PutObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.GrantRead = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantReadACP sets the GrantReadACP field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclInput) SetGrantReadACP(v string) *PutObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.GrantReadACP = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantWrite sets the GrantWrite field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclInput) SetGrantWrite(v string) *PutObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.GrantWrite = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantWriteACP sets the GrantWriteACP field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclInput) SetGrantWriteACP(v string) *PutObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.GrantWriteACP = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclInput) SetKey(v string) *PutObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *PutObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclInput) SetVersionId(v string) *PutObjectAclInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutObjectAclOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectAclOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectAclOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectAclOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *PutObjectAclOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutObjectInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"Body"`
|
|
|
|
// The canned ACL to apply to the object.
|
|
ACL *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-acl" type:"string" enum:"ObjectCannedACL"`
|
|
|
|
// Object data.
|
|
Body io.ReadSeeker `type:"blob"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the bucket to which the PUT operation was initiated.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies caching behavior along the request/reply chain.
|
|
CacheControl *string `location:"header" locationName:"Cache-Control" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies presentational information for the object.
|
|
ContentDisposition *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Disposition" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies what content encodings have been applied to the object and thus
|
|
// what decoding mechanisms must be applied to obtain the media-type referenced
|
|
// by the Content-Type header field.
|
|
ContentEncoding *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Encoding" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The language the content is in.
|
|
ContentLanguage *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Language" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Size of the body in bytes. This parameter is useful when the size of the
|
|
// body cannot be determined automatically.
|
|
ContentLength *int64 `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Length" type:"long"`
|
|
|
|
// The base64-encoded 128-bit MD5 digest of the part data. This parameter is
|
|
// auto-populated when using the command from the CLI
|
|
ContentMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A standard MIME type describing the format of the object data.
|
|
ContentType *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Type" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The date and time at which the object is no longer cacheable.
|
|
Expires *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"Expires" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Gives the grantee READ, READ_ACP, and WRITE_ACP permissions on the object.
|
|
GrantFullControl *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-full-control" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to read the object data and its metadata.
|
|
GrantRead *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-read" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to read the object ACL.
|
|
GrantReadACP *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-read-acp" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Allows grantee to write the ACL for the applicable object.
|
|
GrantWriteACP *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-grant-write-acp" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Object key for which the PUT operation was initiated.
|
|
//
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A map of metadata to store with the object in S3.
|
|
Metadata map[string]*string `location:"headers" locationName:"x-amz-meta-" type:"map"`
|
|
|
|
// The Legal Hold status that you want to apply to the specified object.
|
|
ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-legal-hold" type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus"`
|
|
|
|
// The Object Lock mode that you want to apply to this object.
|
|
ObjectLockMode *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-mode" type:"string" enum:"ObjectLockMode"`
|
|
|
|
// The date and time when you want this object's Object Lock to expire.
|
|
ObjectLockRetainUntilDate *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-object-lock-retain-until-date" type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the algorithm to use to when encrypting the object (e.g., AES256).
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting
|
|
// data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded; Amazon
|
|
// does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with
|
|
// the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm
|
|
// header.
|
|
SSECustomerKey *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321.
|
|
// Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure the encryption
|
|
// key was transmitted without error.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the AWS KMS key ID to use for object encryption. All GET and PUT
|
|
// requests for an object protected by AWS KMS will fail if not made via SSL
|
|
// or using SigV4. Documentation on configuring any of the officially supported
|
|
// AWS SDKs and CLI can be found at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/UsingAWSSDK.html#specify-signature-version
|
|
SSEKMSKeyId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The Server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
|
|
// (e.g., AES256, aws:kms).
|
|
ServerSideEncryption *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption" type:"string" enum:"ServerSideEncryption"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of storage to use for the object. Defaults to 'STANDARD'.
|
|
StorageClass *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-storage-class" type:"string" enum:"StorageClass"`
|
|
|
|
// The tag-set for the object. The tag-set must be encoded as URL Query parameters.
|
|
// (For example, "Key1=Value1")
|
|
Tagging *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-tagging" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the bucket is configured as a website, redirects requests for this object
|
|
// to another object in the same bucket or to an external URL. Amazon S3 stores
|
|
// the value of this header in the object metadata.
|
|
WebsiteRedirectLocation *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-website-redirect-location" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutObjectInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetACL sets the ACL field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetACL(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.ACL = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBody sets the Body field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetBody(v io.ReadSeeker) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.Body = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCacheControl sets the CacheControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetCacheControl(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.CacheControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentDisposition sets the ContentDisposition field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetContentDisposition(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.ContentDisposition = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentEncoding sets the ContentEncoding field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetContentEncoding(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.ContentEncoding = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentLanguage sets the ContentLanguage field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetContentLanguage(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.ContentLanguage = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentLength sets the ContentLength field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetContentLength(v int64) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.ContentLength = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentMD5 sets the ContentMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetContentMD5(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.ContentMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentType sets the ContentType field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetContentType(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.ContentType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpires sets the Expires field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetExpires(v time.Time) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.Expires = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantFullControl sets the GrantFullControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetGrantFullControl(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.GrantFullControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantRead sets the GrantRead field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetGrantRead(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.GrantRead = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantReadACP sets the GrantReadACP field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetGrantReadACP(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.GrantReadACP = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantWriteACP sets the GrantWriteACP field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetGrantWriteACP(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.GrantWriteACP = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetKey(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMetadata sets the Metadata field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetMetadata(v map[string]*string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.Metadata = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockLegalHoldStatus sets the ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetObjectLockLegalHoldStatus(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockMode sets the ObjectLockMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetObjectLockMode(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockRetainUntilDate sets the ObjectLockRetainUntilDate field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetObjectLockRetainUntilDate(v time.Time) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockRetainUntilDate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKey sets the SSECustomerKey field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetSSECustomerKey(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKey = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) getSSECustomerKey() (v string) {
|
|
if s.SSECustomerKey == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.SSECustomerKey
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSEKMSKeyId sets the SSEKMSKeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetSSEKMSKeyId(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.SSEKMSKeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerSideEncryption sets the ServerSideEncryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetServerSideEncryption(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.ServerSideEncryption = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClass sets the StorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetStorageClass(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.StorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTagging sets the Tagging field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetTagging(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.Tagging = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWebsiteRedirectLocation sets the WebsiteRedirectLocation field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectInput) SetWebsiteRedirectLocation(v string) *PutObjectInput {
|
|
s.WebsiteRedirectLocation = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutObjectLegalHoldInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"LegalHold"`
|
|
|
|
// The bucket containing the object that you want to place a Legal Hold on.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The key name for the object that you want to place a Legal Hold on.
|
|
//
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Container element for the Legal Hold configuration you want to apply to the
|
|
// specified object.
|
|
LegalHold *ObjectLockLegalHold `locationName:"LegalHold" type:"structure" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// The version ID of the object that you want to place a Legal Hold on.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"versionId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectLegalHoldInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectLegalHoldInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLegalHoldInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutObjectLegalHoldInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLegalHoldInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutObjectLegalHoldInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLegalHoldInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLegalHoldInput) SetKey(v string) *PutObjectLegalHoldInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLegalHold sets the LegalHold field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLegalHoldInput) SetLegalHold(v *ObjectLockLegalHold) *PutObjectLegalHoldInput {
|
|
s.LegalHold = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLegalHoldInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *PutObjectLegalHoldInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLegalHoldInput) SetVersionId(v string) *PutObjectLegalHoldInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutObjectLegalHoldOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectLegalHoldOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectLegalHoldOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLegalHoldOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *PutObjectLegalHoldOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutObjectLockConfigurationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"ObjectLockConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// The bucket whose Object Lock configuration you want to create or replace.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The Object Lock configuration that you want to apply to the specified bucket.
|
|
ObjectLockConfiguration *ObjectLockConfiguration `locationName:"ObjectLockConfiguration" type:"structure" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// A token to allow Object Lock to be enabled for an existing bucket.
|
|
Token *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-bucket-object-lock-token" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectLockConfigurationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectLockConfigurationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLockConfigurationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutObjectLockConfigurationInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLockConfigurationInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutObjectLockConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLockConfigurationInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetObjectLockConfiguration sets the ObjectLockConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLockConfigurationInput) SetObjectLockConfiguration(v *ObjectLockConfiguration) *PutObjectLockConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.ObjectLockConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLockConfigurationInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *PutObjectLockConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetToken sets the Token field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLockConfigurationInput) SetToken(v string) *PutObjectLockConfigurationInput {
|
|
s.Token = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutObjectLockConfigurationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectLockConfigurationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectLockConfigurationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectLockConfigurationOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *PutObjectLockConfigurationOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutObjectOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Entity tag for the uploaded object.
|
|
ETag *string `location:"header" locationName:"ETag" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If the object expiration is configured, this will contain the expiration
|
|
// date (expiry-date) and rule ID (rule-id). The value of rule-id is URL encoded.
|
|
Expiration *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-expiration" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header confirming the encryption algorithm
|
|
// used.
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header to provide round trip message integrity
|
|
// verification of the customer-provided encryption key.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, specifies the ID of the AWS Key Management Service (KMS) master
|
|
// encryption key that was used for the object.
|
|
SSEKMSKeyId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The Server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
|
|
// (e.g., AES256, aws:kms).
|
|
ServerSideEncryption *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption" type:"string" enum:"ServerSideEncryption"`
|
|
|
|
// Version of the object.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-version-id" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetETag sets the ETag field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectOutput) SetETag(v string) *PutObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ETag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpiration sets the Expiration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectOutput) SetExpiration(v string) *PutObjectOutput {
|
|
s.Expiration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *PutObjectOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectOutput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *PutObjectOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectOutput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *PutObjectOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSEKMSKeyId sets the SSEKMSKeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectOutput) SetSSEKMSKeyId(v string) *PutObjectOutput {
|
|
s.SSEKMSKeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerSideEncryption sets the ServerSideEncryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectOutput) SetServerSideEncryption(v string) *PutObjectOutput {
|
|
s.ServerSideEncryption = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectOutput) SetVersionId(v string) *PutObjectOutput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutObjectRetentionInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"Retention"`
|
|
|
|
// The bucket that contains the object you want to apply this Object Retention
|
|
// configuration to.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether this operation should bypass Governance-mode restrictions.j
|
|
BypassGovernanceRetention *bool `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-bypass-governance-retention" type:"boolean"`
|
|
|
|
// The key name for the object that you want to apply this Object Retention
|
|
// configuration to.
|
|
//
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// The container element for the Object Retention configuration.
|
|
Retention *ObjectLockRetention `locationName:"Retention" type:"structure" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
|
|
// The version ID for the object that you want to apply this Object Retention
|
|
// configuration to.
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"versionId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectRetentionInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectRetentionInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectRetentionInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutObjectRetentionInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectRetentionInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutObjectRetentionInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutObjectRetentionInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBypassGovernanceRetention sets the BypassGovernanceRetention field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectRetentionInput) SetBypassGovernanceRetention(v bool) *PutObjectRetentionInput {
|
|
s.BypassGovernanceRetention = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectRetentionInput) SetKey(v string) *PutObjectRetentionInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectRetentionInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *PutObjectRetentionInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRetention sets the Retention field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectRetentionInput) SetRetention(v *ObjectLockRetention) *PutObjectRetentionInput {
|
|
s.Retention = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectRetentionInput) SetVersionId(v string) *PutObjectRetentionInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutObjectRetentionOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectRetentionOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectRetentionOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectRetentionOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *PutObjectRetentionOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutObjectTaggingInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"Tagging"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Tagging is a required field
|
|
Tagging *Tagging `locationName:"Tagging" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"versionId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectTaggingInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectTaggingInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectTaggingInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutObjectTaggingInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Tagging == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Tagging"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Tagging != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Tagging.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Tagging", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectTaggingInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutObjectTaggingInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutObjectTaggingInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectTaggingInput) SetKey(v string) *PutObjectTaggingInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTagging sets the Tagging field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectTaggingInput) SetTagging(v *Tagging) *PutObjectTaggingInput {
|
|
s.Tagging = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectTaggingInput) SetVersionId(v string) *PutObjectTaggingInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutObjectTaggingOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-version-id" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectTaggingOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutObjectTaggingOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutObjectTaggingOutput) SetVersionId(v string) *PutObjectTaggingOutput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutPublicAccessBlockInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"PublicAccessBlockConfiguration"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the Amazon S3 bucket whose PublicAccessBlock configuration you
|
|
// want to set.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The PublicAccessBlock configuration that you want to apply to this Amazon
|
|
// S3 bucket. You can enable the configuration options in any combination. For
|
|
// more information about when Amazon S3 considers a bucket or object public,
|
|
// see The Meaning of "Public" (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/access-control-block-public-access.html#access-control-block-public-access-policy-status)
|
|
// in the Amazon Simple Storage Service Developer Guide.
|
|
//
|
|
// PublicAccessBlockConfiguration is a required field
|
|
PublicAccessBlockConfiguration *PublicAccessBlockConfiguration `locationName:"PublicAccessBlockConfiguration" type:"structure" required:"true" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutPublicAccessBlockInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutPublicAccessBlockInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PutPublicAccessBlockInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PutPublicAccessBlockInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PublicAccessBlockConfiguration == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PublicAccessBlockConfiguration"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutPublicAccessBlockInput) SetBucket(v string) *PutPublicAccessBlockInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *PutPublicAccessBlockInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPublicAccessBlockConfiguration sets the PublicAccessBlockConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *PutPublicAccessBlockInput) SetPublicAccessBlockConfiguration(v *PublicAccessBlockConfiguration) *PutPublicAccessBlockInput {
|
|
s.PublicAccessBlockConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PutPublicAccessBlockOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutPublicAccessBlockOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PutPublicAccessBlockOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for specifying the configuration for publication of messages
|
|
// to an Amazon Simple Queue Service (Amazon SQS) queue.when Amazon S3 detects
|
|
// specified events.
|
|
type QueueConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Events is a required field
|
|
Events []*string `locationName:"Event" type:"list" flattened:"true" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for object key name filtering rules. For information about key
|
|
// name filtering, see Configuring Event Notifications (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/NotificationHowTo.html)
|
|
// in the Amazon Simple Storage Service Developer Guide.
|
|
Filter *NotificationConfigurationFilter `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An optional unique identifier for configurations in a notification configuration.
|
|
// If you don't provide one, Amazon S3 will assign an ID.
|
|
Id *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the Amazon SQS queue to which Amazon S3
|
|
// will publish a message when it detects events of the specified type.
|
|
//
|
|
// QueueArn is a required field
|
|
QueueArn *string `locationName:"Queue" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s QueueConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s QueueConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *QueueConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "QueueConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.Events == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Events"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.QueueArn == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("QueueArn"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEvents sets the Events field's value.
|
|
func (s *QueueConfiguration) SetEvents(v []*string) *QueueConfiguration {
|
|
s.Events = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilter sets the Filter field's value.
|
|
func (s *QueueConfiguration) SetFilter(v *NotificationConfigurationFilter) *QueueConfiguration {
|
|
s.Filter = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *QueueConfiguration) SetId(v string) *QueueConfiguration {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetQueueArn sets the QueueArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *QueueConfiguration) SetQueueArn(v string) *QueueConfiguration {
|
|
s.QueueArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type QueueConfigurationDeprecated struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The bucket event for which to send notifications.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: Event has been deprecated
|
|
Event *string `deprecated:"true" type:"string" enum:"Event"`
|
|
|
|
Events []*string `locationName:"Event" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// An optional unique identifier for configurations in a notification configuration.
|
|
// If you don't provide one, Amazon S3 will assign an ID.
|
|
Id *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Queue *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s QueueConfigurationDeprecated) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s QueueConfigurationDeprecated) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEvent sets the Event field's value.
|
|
func (s *QueueConfigurationDeprecated) SetEvent(v string) *QueueConfigurationDeprecated {
|
|
s.Event = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEvents sets the Events field's value.
|
|
func (s *QueueConfigurationDeprecated) SetEvents(v []*string) *QueueConfigurationDeprecated {
|
|
s.Events = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *QueueConfigurationDeprecated) SetId(v string) *QueueConfigurationDeprecated {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetQueue sets the Queue field's value.
|
|
func (s *QueueConfigurationDeprecated) SetQueue(v string) *QueueConfigurationDeprecated {
|
|
s.Queue = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type RecordsEvent struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `locationName:"RecordsEvent" type:"structure" payload:"Payload"`
|
|
|
|
// The byte array of partial, one or more result records.
|
|
//
|
|
// Payload is automatically base64 encoded/decoded by the SDK.
|
|
Payload []byte `type:"blob"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RecordsEvent) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RecordsEvent) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPayload sets the Payload field's value.
|
|
func (s *RecordsEvent) SetPayload(v []byte) *RecordsEvent {
|
|
s.Payload = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The RecordsEvent is and event in the SelectObjectContentEventStream group of events.
|
|
func (s *RecordsEvent) eventSelectObjectContentEventStream() {}
|
|
|
|
// UnmarshalEvent unmarshals the EventStream Message into the RecordsEvent value.
|
|
// This method is only used internally within the SDK's EventStream handling.
|
|
func (s *RecordsEvent) UnmarshalEvent(
|
|
payloadUnmarshaler protocol.PayloadUnmarshaler,
|
|
msg eventstream.Message,
|
|
) error {
|
|
s.Payload = make([]byte, len(msg.Payload))
|
|
copy(s.Payload, msg.Payload)
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Redirect struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The host name to use in the redirect request.
|
|
HostName *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The HTTP redirect code to use on the response. Not required if one of the
|
|
// siblings is present.
|
|
HttpRedirectCode *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Protocol to use (http, https) when redirecting requests. The default is the
|
|
// protocol that is used in the original request.
|
|
Protocol *string `type:"string" enum:"Protocol"`
|
|
|
|
// The object key prefix to use in the redirect request. For example, to redirect
|
|
// requests for all pages with prefix docs/ (objects in the docs/ folder) to
|
|
// documents/, you can set a condition block with KeyPrefixEquals set to docs/
|
|
// and in the Redirect set ReplaceKeyPrefixWith to /documents. Not required
|
|
// if one of the siblings is present. Can be present only if ReplaceKeyWith
|
|
// is not provided.
|
|
ReplaceKeyPrefixWith *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The specific object key to use in the redirect request. For example, redirect
|
|
// request to error.html. Not required if one of the sibling is present. Can
|
|
// be present only if ReplaceKeyPrefixWith is not provided.
|
|
ReplaceKeyWith *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Redirect) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Redirect) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHostName sets the HostName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Redirect) SetHostName(v string) *Redirect {
|
|
s.HostName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHttpRedirectCode sets the HttpRedirectCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *Redirect) SetHttpRedirectCode(v string) *Redirect {
|
|
s.HttpRedirectCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetProtocol sets the Protocol field's value.
|
|
func (s *Redirect) SetProtocol(v string) *Redirect {
|
|
s.Protocol = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReplaceKeyPrefixWith sets the ReplaceKeyPrefixWith field's value.
|
|
func (s *Redirect) SetReplaceKeyPrefixWith(v string) *Redirect {
|
|
s.ReplaceKeyPrefixWith = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReplaceKeyWith sets the ReplaceKeyWith field's value.
|
|
func (s *Redirect) SetReplaceKeyWith(v string) *Redirect {
|
|
s.ReplaceKeyWith = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type RedirectAllRequestsTo struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the host where requests will be redirected.
|
|
//
|
|
// HostName is a required field
|
|
HostName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Protocol to use (http, https) when redirecting requests. The default is the
|
|
// protocol that is used in the original request.
|
|
Protocol *string `type:"string" enum:"Protocol"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RedirectAllRequestsTo) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RedirectAllRequestsTo) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *RedirectAllRequestsTo) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RedirectAllRequestsTo"}
|
|
if s.HostName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("HostName"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHostName sets the HostName field's value.
|
|
func (s *RedirectAllRequestsTo) SetHostName(v string) *RedirectAllRequestsTo {
|
|
s.HostName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetProtocol sets the Protocol field's value.
|
|
func (s *RedirectAllRequestsTo) SetProtocol(v string) *RedirectAllRequestsTo {
|
|
s.Protocol = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for replication rules. You can add up to 1,000 rules. The maximum
|
|
// size of a replication configuration is 2 MB.
|
|
type ReplicationConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the AWS Identity and Access Management
|
|
// (IAM) role that Amazon S3 can assume when replicating the objects.
|
|
//
|
|
// Role is a required field
|
|
Role *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for one or more replication rules. A replication configuration
|
|
// must have at least one rule and can contain a maximum of 1,000 rules.
|
|
//
|
|
// Rules is a required field
|
|
Rules []*ReplicationRule `locationName:"Rule" type:"list" flattened:"true" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ReplicationConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ReplicationConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ReplicationConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.Role == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Role"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Rules == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Rules"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Rules != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Rules {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Rules", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRole sets the Role field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationConfiguration) SetRole(v string) *ReplicationConfiguration {
|
|
s.Role = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRules sets the Rules field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationConfiguration) SetRules(v []*ReplicationRule) *ReplicationConfiguration {
|
|
s.Rules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for information about a specific replication rule.
|
|
type ReplicationRule struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether Amazon S3 should replicate delete makers.
|
|
DeleteMarkerReplication *DeleteMarkerReplication `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for information about the replication destination.
|
|
//
|
|
// Destination is a required field
|
|
Destination *Destination `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A filter that identifies the subset of objects to which the replication rule
|
|
// applies. A Filter must specify exactly one Prefix, Tag, or an And child element.
|
|
Filter *ReplicationRuleFilter `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A unique identifier for the rule. The maximum value is 255 characters.
|
|
ID *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// An object keyname prefix that identifies the object or objects to which the
|
|
// rule applies. The maximum prefix length is 1,024 characters.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: Prefix has been deprecated
|
|
Prefix *string `deprecated:"true" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The priority associated with the rule. If you specify multiple rules in a
|
|
// replication configuration, Amazon S3 prioritizes the rules to prevent conflicts
|
|
// when filtering. If two or more rules identify the same object based on a
|
|
// specified filter, the rule with higher priority takes precedence. For example:
|
|
//
|
|
// * Same object quality prefix based filter criteria If prefixes you specified
|
|
// in multiple rules overlap
|
|
//
|
|
// * Same object qualify tag based filter criteria specified in multiple
|
|
// rules
|
|
//
|
|
// For more information, see Cross-Region Replication (CRR) ( https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/crr.html)
|
|
// in the Amazon S3 Developer Guide.
|
|
Priority *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// A container that describes additional filters for identifying the source
|
|
// objects that you want to replicate. You can choose to enable or disable the
|
|
// replication of these objects. Currently, Amazon S3 supports only the filter
|
|
// that you can specify for objects created with server-side encryption using
|
|
// an AWS KMS-Managed Key (SSE-KMS).
|
|
//
|
|
// If you want Amazon S3 to replicate objects created with server-side encryption
|
|
// using AWS KMS-Managed Keys.
|
|
SourceSelectionCriteria *SourceSelectionCriteria `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If status isn't enabled, the rule is ignored.
|
|
//
|
|
// Status is a required field
|
|
Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"ReplicationRuleStatus"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ReplicationRule) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ReplicationRule) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRule) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ReplicationRule"}
|
|
if s.Destination == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Status == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Status"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Destination != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Destination.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Destination", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Filter != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Filter.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Filter", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SourceSelectionCriteria != nil {
|
|
if err := s.SourceSelectionCriteria.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("SourceSelectionCriteria", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeleteMarkerReplication sets the DeleteMarkerReplication field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRule) SetDeleteMarkerReplication(v *DeleteMarkerReplication) *ReplicationRule {
|
|
s.DeleteMarkerReplication = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestination sets the Destination field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRule) SetDestination(v *Destination) *ReplicationRule {
|
|
s.Destination = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilter sets the Filter field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRule) SetFilter(v *ReplicationRuleFilter) *ReplicationRule {
|
|
s.Filter = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetID sets the ID field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRule) SetID(v string) *ReplicationRule {
|
|
s.ID = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRule) SetPrefix(v string) *ReplicationRule {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPriority sets the Priority field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRule) SetPriority(v int64) *ReplicationRule {
|
|
s.Priority = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSourceSelectionCriteria sets the SourceSelectionCriteria field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRule) SetSourceSelectionCriteria(v *SourceSelectionCriteria) *ReplicationRule {
|
|
s.SourceSelectionCriteria = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRule) SetStatus(v string) *ReplicationRule {
|
|
s.Status = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ReplicationRuleAndOperator struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Tags []*Tag `locationName:"Tag" locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ReplicationRuleAndOperator) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ReplicationRuleAndOperator) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRuleAndOperator) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ReplicationRuleAndOperator"}
|
|
if s.Tags != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Tags {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Tags", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRuleAndOperator) SetPrefix(v string) *ReplicationRuleAndOperator {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTags sets the Tags field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRuleAndOperator) SetTags(v []*Tag) *ReplicationRuleAndOperator {
|
|
s.Tags = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A filter that identifies the subset of objects to which the replication rule
|
|
// applies. A Filter must specify exactly one Prefix, Tag, or an And child element.
|
|
type ReplicationRuleFilter struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for specifying rule filters. The filters determine the subset
|
|
// of objects to which the rule applies. This element is required only if you
|
|
// specify more than one filter. For example:
|
|
//
|
|
// * If you specify both a Prefix and a Tag filter, wrap these filters in
|
|
// an And tag.
|
|
//
|
|
// * If you specify a filter based on multiple tags, wrap the Tag elements
|
|
// in an And tag.
|
|
And *ReplicationRuleAndOperator `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An object keyname prefix that identifies the subset of objects to which the
|
|
// rule applies.
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for specifying a tag key and value.
|
|
//
|
|
// The rule applies only to objects that have the tag in their tag set.
|
|
Tag *Tag `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ReplicationRuleFilter) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ReplicationRuleFilter) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRuleFilter) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ReplicationRuleFilter"}
|
|
if s.And != nil {
|
|
if err := s.And.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("And", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Tag != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Tag.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Tag", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAnd sets the And field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRuleFilter) SetAnd(v *ReplicationRuleAndOperator) *ReplicationRuleFilter {
|
|
s.And = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRuleFilter) SetPrefix(v string) *ReplicationRuleFilter {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTag sets the Tag field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReplicationRuleFilter) SetTag(v *Tag) *ReplicationRuleFilter {
|
|
s.Tag = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type RequestPaymentConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies who pays for the download and request fees.
|
|
//
|
|
// Payer is a required field
|
|
Payer *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"Payer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RequestPaymentConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RequestPaymentConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *RequestPaymentConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RequestPaymentConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.Payer == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Payer"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPayer sets the Payer field's value.
|
|
func (s *RequestPaymentConfiguration) SetPayer(v string) *RequestPaymentConfiguration {
|
|
s.Payer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type RequestProgress struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether periodic QueryProgress frames should be sent. Valid values:
|
|
// TRUE, FALSE. Default value: FALSE.
|
|
Enabled *bool `type:"boolean"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RequestProgress) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RequestProgress) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEnabled sets the Enabled field's value.
|
|
func (s *RequestProgress) SetEnabled(v bool) *RequestProgress {
|
|
s.Enabled = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type RestoreObjectInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"RestoreRequest"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// Container for restore job parameters.
|
|
RestoreRequest *RestoreRequest `locationName:"RestoreRequest" type:"structure" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
|
|
VersionId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"versionId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RestoreObjectInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RestoreObjectInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *RestoreObjectInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreObjectInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RestoreRequest != nil {
|
|
if err := s.RestoreRequest.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("RestoreRequest", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreObjectInput) SetBucket(v string) *RestoreObjectInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *RestoreObjectInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreObjectInput) SetKey(v string) *RestoreObjectInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreObjectInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *RestoreObjectInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRestoreRequest sets the RestoreRequest field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreObjectInput) SetRestoreRequest(v *RestoreRequest) *RestoreObjectInput {
|
|
s.RestoreRequest = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVersionId sets the VersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreObjectInput) SetVersionId(v string) *RestoreObjectInput {
|
|
s.VersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type RestoreObjectOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates the path in the provided S3 output location where Select results
|
|
// will be restored to.
|
|
RestoreOutputPath *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-restore-output-path" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RestoreObjectOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RestoreObjectOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreObjectOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *RestoreObjectOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRestoreOutputPath sets the RestoreOutputPath field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreObjectOutput) SetRestoreOutputPath(v string) *RestoreObjectOutput {
|
|
s.RestoreOutputPath = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Container for restore job parameters.
|
|
type RestoreRequest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Lifetime of the active copy in days. Do not use with restores that specify
|
|
// OutputLocation.
|
|
Days *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The optional description for the job.
|
|
Description *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Glacier related parameters pertaining to this job. Do not use with restores
|
|
// that specify OutputLocation.
|
|
GlacierJobParameters *GlacierJobParameters `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Describes the location where the restore job's output is stored.
|
|
OutputLocation *OutputLocation `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Describes the parameters for Select job types.
|
|
SelectParameters *SelectParameters `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Glacier retrieval tier at which the restore will be processed.
|
|
Tier *string `type:"string" enum:"Tier"`
|
|
|
|
// Type of restore request.
|
|
Type *string `type:"string" enum:"RestoreRequestType"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RestoreRequest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RestoreRequest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *RestoreRequest) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreRequest"}
|
|
if s.GlacierJobParameters != nil {
|
|
if err := s.GlacierJobParameters.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("GlacierJobParameters", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OutputLocation != nil {
|
|
if err := s.OutputLocation.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("OutputLocation", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SelectParameters != nil {
|
|
if err := s.SelectParameters.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("SelectParameters", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDays sets the Days field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreRequest) SetDays(v int64) *RestoreRequest {
|
|
s.Days = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDescription sets the Description field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreRequest) SetDescription(v string) *RestoreRequest {
|
|
s.Description = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGlacierJobParameters sets the GlacierJobParameters field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreRequest) SetGlacierJobParameters(v *GlacierJobParameters) *RestoreRequest {
|
|
s.GlacierJobParameters = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputLocation sets the OutputLocation field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreRequest) SetOutputLocation(v *OutputLocation) *RestoreRequest {
|
|
s.OutputLocation = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSelectParameters sets the SelectParameters field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreRequest) SetSelectParameters(v *SelectParameters) *RestoreRequest {
|
|
s.SelectParameters = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTier sets the Tier field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreRequest) SetTier(v string) *RestoreRequest {
|
|
s.Tier = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetType sets the Type field's value.
|
|
func (s *RestoreRequest) SetType(v string) *RestoreRequest {
|
|
s.Type = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type RoutingRule struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for describing a condition that must be met for the specified
|
|
// redirect to apply. For example, 1. If request is for pages in the /docs folder,
|
|
// redirect to the /documents folder. 2. If request results in HTTP error 4xx,
|
|
// redirect request to another host where you might process the error.
|
|
Condition *Condition `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Container for redirect information. You can redirect requests to another
|
|
// host, to another page, or with another protocol. In the event of an error,
|
|
// you can specify a different error code to return.
|
|
//
|
|
// Redirect is a required field
|
|
Redirect *Redirect `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RoutingRule) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RoutingRule) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *RoutingRule) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RoutingRule"}
|
|
if s.Redirect == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Redirect"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCondition sets the Condition field's value.
|
|
func (s *RoutingRule) SetCondition(v *Condition) *RoutingRule {
|
|
s.Condition = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRedirect sets the Redirect field's value.
|
|
func (s *RoutingRule) SetRedirect(v *Redirect) *RoutingRule {
|
|
s.Redirect = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Rule struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the days since the initiation of an Incomplete Multipart Upload
|
|
// that Lifecycle will wait before permanently removing all parts of the upload.
|
|
AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload *AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Expiration *LifecycleExpiration `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Unique identifier for the rule. The value cannot be longer than 255 characters.
|
|
ID *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies when noncurrent object versions expire. Upon expiration, Amazon
|
|
// S3 permanently deletes the noncurrent object versions. You set this lifecycle
|
|
// configuration action on a bucket that has versioning enabled (or suspended)
|
|
// to request that Amazon S3 delete noncurrent object versions at a specific
|
|
// period in the object's lifetime.
|
|
NoncurrentVersionExpiration *NoncurrentVersionExpiration `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Container for the transition rule that describes when noncurrent objects
|
|
// transition to the STANDARD_IA, ONEZONE_IA, INTELLIGENT_TIERING, GLACIER or
|
|
// DEEP_ARCHIVE storage class. If your bucket is versioning-enabled (or versioning
|
|
// is suspended), you can set this action to request that Amazon S3 transition
|
|
// noncurrent object versions to the STANDARD_IA, ONEZONE_IA, INTELLIGENT_TIERING,
|
|
// GLACIER or DEEP_ARCHIVE storage class at a specific period in the object's
|
|
// lifetime.
|
|
NoncurrentVersionTransition *NoncurrentVersionTransition `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Prefix identifying one or more objects to which the rule applies.
|
|
//
|
|
// Prefix is a required field
|
|
Prefix *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// If 'Enabled', the rule is currently being applied. If 'Disabled', the rule
|
|
// is not currently being applied.
|
|
//
|
|
// Status is a required field
|
|
Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"ExpirationStatus"`
|
|
|
|
Transition *Transition `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Rule) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Rule) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Rule) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Rule"}
|
|
if s.Prefix == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Prefix"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Status == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Status"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAbortIncompleteMultipartUpload sets the AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload field's value.
|
|
func (s *Rule) SetAbortIncompleteMultipartUpload(v *AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload) *Rule {
|
|
s.AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpiration sets the Expiration field's value.
|
|
func (s *Rule) SetExpiration(v *LifecycleExpiration) *Rule {
|
|
s.Expiration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetID sets the ID field's value.
|
|
func (s *Rule) SetID(v string) *Rule {
|
|
s.ID = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNoncurrentVersionExpiration sets the NoncurrentVersionExpiration field's value.
|
|
func (s *Rule) SetNoncurrentVersionExpiration(v *NoncurrentVersionExpiration) *Rule {
|
|
s.NoncurrentVersionExpiration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNoncurrentVersionTransition sets the NoncurrentVersionTransition field's value.
|
|
func (s *Rule) SetNoncurrentVersionTransition(v *NoncurrentVersionTransition) *Rule {
|
|
s.NoncurrentVersionTransition = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPrefix sets the Prefix field's value.
|
|
func (s *Rule) SetPrefix(v string) *Rule {
|
|
s.Prefix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
|
|
func (s *Rule) SetStatus(v string) *Rule {
|
|
s.Status = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTransition sets the Transition field's value.
|
|
func (s *Rule) SetTransition(v *Transition) *Rule {
|
|
s.Transition = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the use of SSE-KMS to encrypt delivered Inventory reports.
|
|
type SSEKMS struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `locationName:"SSE-KMS" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the ID of the AWS Key Management Service (KMS) master encryption
|
|
// key to use for encrypting Inventory reports.
|
|
//
|
|
// KeyId is a required field
|
|
KeyId *string `type:"string" required:"true" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SSEKMS) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SSEKMS) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *SSEKMS) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "SSEKMS"}
|
|
if s.KeyId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("KeyId"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKeyId sets the KeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *SSEKMS) SetKeyId(v string) *SSEKMS {
|
|
s.KeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the use of SSE-S3 to encrypt delivered Inventory reports.
|
|
type SSES3 struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `locationName:"SSE-S3" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SSES3) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SSES3) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SelectObjectContentEventStream provides handling of EventStreams for
|
|
// the SelectObjectContent API.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use this type to receive SelectObjectContentEventStream events. The events
|
|
// can be read from the Events channel member.
|
|
//
|
|
// The events that can be received are:
|
|
//
|
|
// * ContinuationEvent
|
|
// * EndEvent
|
|
// * ProgressEvent
|
|
// * RecordsEvent
|
|
// * StatsEvent
|
|
type SelectObjectContentEventStream struct {
|
|
// Reader is the EventStream reader for the SelectObjectContentEventStream
|
|
// events. This value is automatically set by the SDK when the API call is made
|
|
// Use this member when unit testing your code with the SDK to mock out the
|
|
// EventStream Reader.
|
|
//
|
|
// Must not be nil.
|
|
Reader SelectObjectContentEventStreamReader
|
|
|
|
// StreamCloser is the io.Closer for the EventStream connection. For HTTP
|
|
// EventStream this is the response Body. The stream will be closed when
|
|
// the Close method of the EventStream is called.
|
|
StreamCloser io.Closer
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Close closes the EventStream. This will also cause the Events channel to be
|
|
// closed. You can use the closing of the Events channel to terminate your
|
|
// application's read from the API's EventStream.
|
|
//
|
|
// Will close the underlying EventStream reader. For EventStream over HTTP
|
|
// connection this will also close the HTTP connection.
|
|
//
|
|
// Close must be called when done using the EventStream API. Not calling Close
|
|
// may result in resource leaks.
|
|
func (es *SelectObjectContentEventStream) Close() (err error) {
|
|
es.Reader.Close()
|
|
return es.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Err returns any error that occurred while reading EventStream Events from
|
|
// the service API's response. Returns nil if there were no errors.
|
|
func (es *SelectObjectContentEventStream) Err() error {
|
|
if err := es.Reader.Err(); err != nil {
|
|
return err
|
|
}
|
|
es.StreamCloser.Close()
|
|
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Events returns a channel to read EventStream Events from the
|
|
// SelectObjectContent API.
|
|
//
|
|
// These events are:
|
|
//
|
|
// * ContinuationEvent
|
|
// * EndEvent
|
|
// * ProgressEvent
|
|
// * RecordsEvent
|
|
// * StatsEvent
|
|
func (es *SelectObjectContentEventStream) Events() <-chan SelectObjectContentEventStreamEvent {
|
|
return es.Reader.Events()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SelectObjectContentEventStreamEvent groups together all EventStream
|
|
// events read from the SelectObjectContent API.
|
|
//
|
|
// These events are:
|
|
//
|
|
// * ContinuationEvent
|
|
// * EndEvent
|
|
// * ProgressEvent
|
|
// * RecordsEvent
|
|
// * StatsEvent
|
|
type SelectObjectContentEventStreamEvent interface {
|
|
eventSelectObjectContentEventStream()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SelectObjectContentEventStreamReader provides the interface for reading EventStream
|
|
// Events from the SelectObjectContent API. The
|
|
// default implementation for this interface will be SelectObjectContentEventStream.
|
|
//
|
|
// The reader's Close method must allow multiple concurrent calls.
|
|
//
|
|
// These events are:
|
|
//
|
|
// * ContinuationEvent
|
|
// * EndEvent
|
|
// * ProgressEvent
|
|
// * RecordsEvent
|
|
// * StatsEvent
|
|
type SelectObjectContentEventStreamReader interface {
|
|
// Returns a channel of events as they are read from the event stream.
|
|
Events() <-chan SelectObjectContentEventStreamEvent
|
|
|
|
// Close will close the underlying event stream reader. For event stream over
|
|
// HTTP this will also close the HTTP connection.
|
|
Close() error
|
|
|
|
// Returns any error that has occurred while reading from the event stream.
|
|
Err() error
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type readSelectObjectContentEventStream struct {
|
|
eventReader *eventstreamapi.EventReader
|
|
stream chan SelectObjectContentEventStreamEvent
|
|
errVal atomic.Value
|
|
|
|
done chan struct{}
|
|
closeOnce sync.Once
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func newReadSelectObjectContentEventStream(
|
|
reader io.ReadCloser,
|
|
unmarshalers request.HandlerList,
|
|
logger aws.Logger,
|
|
logLevel aws.LogLevelType,
|
|
) *readSelectObjectContentEventStream {
|
|
r := &readSelectObjectContentEventStream{
|
|
stream: make(chan SelectObjectContentEventStreamEvent),
|
|
done: make(chan struct{}),
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
r.eventReader = eventstreamapi.NewEventReader(
|
|
reader,
|
|
protocol.HandlerPayloadUnmarshal{
|
|
Unmarshalers: unmarshalers,
|
|
},
|
|
r.unmarshalerForEventType,
|
|
)
|
|
r.eventReader.UseLogger(logger, logLevel)
|
|
|
|
return r
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Close will close the underlying event stream reader. For EventStream over
|
|
// HTTP this will also close the HTTP connection.
|
|
func (r *readSelectObjectContentEventStream) Close() error {
|
|
r.closeOnce.Do(r.safeClose)
|
|
|
|
return r.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (r *readSelectObjectContentEventStream) safeClose() {
|
|
close(r.done)
|
|
err := r.eventReader.Close()
|
|
if err != nil {
|
|
r.errVal.Store(err)
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (r *readSelectObjectContentEventStream) Err() error {
|
|
if v := r.errVal.Load(); v != nil {
|
|
return v.(error)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (r *readSelectObjectContentEventStream) Events() <-chan SelectObjectContentEventStreamEvent {
|
|
return r.stream
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (r *readSelectObjectContentEventStream) readEventStream() {
|
|
defer close(r.stream)
|
|
|
|
for {
|
|
event, err := r.eventReader.ReadEvent()
|
|
if err != nil {
|
|
if err == io.EOF {
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
select {
|
|
case <-r.done:
|
|
// If closed already ignore the error
|
|
return
|
|
default:
|
|
}
|
|
r.errVal.Store(err)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
select {
|
|
case r.stream <- event.(SelectObjectContentEventStreamEvent):
|
|
case <-r.done:
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (r *readSelectObjectContentEventStream) unmarshalerForEventType(
|
|
eventType string,
|
|
) (eventstreamapi.Unmarshaler, error) {
|
|
switch eventType {
|
|
case "Cont":
|
|
return &ContinuationEvent{}, nil
|
|
|
|
case "End":
|
|
return &EndEvent{}, nil
|
|
|
|
case "Progress":
|
|
return &ProgressEvent{}, nil
|
|
|
|
case "Records":
|
|
return &RecordsEvent{}, nil
|
|
|
|
case "Stats":
|
|
return &StatsEvent{}, nil
|
|
default:
|
|
return nil, awserr.New(
|
|
request.ErrCodeSerialization,
|
|
fmt.Sprintf("unknown event type name, %s, for SelectObjectContentEventStream", eventType),
|
|
nil,
|
|
)
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Request to filter the contents of an Amazon S3 object based on a simple Structured
|
|
// Query Language (SQL) statement. In the request, along with the SQL expression,
|
|
// you must specify a data serialization format (JSON or CSV) of the object.
|
|
// Amazon S3 uses this to parse object data into records. It returns only records
|
|
// that match the specified SQL expression. You must also specify the data serialization
|
|
// format for the response. For more information, see S3Select API Documentation
|
|
// (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/RESTObjectSELECTContent.html).
|
|
type SelectObjectContentInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `locationName:"SelectObjectContentRequest" type:"structure" xmlURI:"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"`
|
|
|
|
// The S3 bucket.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The expression that is used to query the object.
|
|
//
|
|
// Expression is a required field
|
|
Expression *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of the provided expression (for example., SQL).
|
|
//
|
|
// ExpressionType is a required field
|
|
ExpressionType *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"ExpressionType"`
|
|
|
|
// Describes the format of the data in the object that is being queried.
|
|
//
|
|
// InputSerialization is a required field
|
|
InputSerialization *InputSerialization `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The object key.
|
|
//
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Describes the format of the data that you want Amazon S3 to return in response.
|
|
//
|
|
// OutputSerialization is a required field
|
|
OutputSerialization *OutputSerialization `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies if periodic request progress information should be enabled.
|
|
RequestProgress *RequestProgress `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The SSE Algorithm used to encrypt the object. For more information, see
|
|
// Server-Side Encryption (Using Customer-Provided Encryption Keys (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ServerSideEncryptionCustomerKeys.html).
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The SSE Customer Key. For more information, see Server-Side Encryption (Using
|
|
// Customer-Provided Encryption Keys (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ServerSideEncryptionCustomerKeys.html).
|
|
SSECustomerKey *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The SSE Customer Key MD5. For more information, see Server-Side Encryption
|
|
// (Using Customer-Provided Encryption Keys (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ServerSideEncryptionCustomerKeys.html).
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SelectObjectContentInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SelectObjectContentInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "SelectObjectContentInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Expression == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Expression"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ExpressionType == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ExpressionType"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputSerialization == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputSerialization"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OutputSerialization == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OutputSerialization"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentInput) SetBucket(v string) *SelectObjectContentInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpression sets the Expression field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentInput) SetExpression(v string) *SelectObjectContentInput {
|
|
s.Expression = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpressionType sets the ExpressionType field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentInput) SetExpressionType(v string) *SelectObjectContentInput {
|
|
s.ExpressionType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSerialization sets the InputSerialization field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentInput) SetInputSerialization(v *InputSerialization) *SelectObjectContentInput {
|
|
s.InputSerialization = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentInput) SetKey(v string) *SelectObjectContentInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputSerialization sets the OutputSerialization field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentInput) SetOutputSerialization(v *OutputSerialization) *SelectObjectContentInput {
|
|
s.OutputSerialization = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestProgress sets the RequestProgress field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentInput) SetRequestProgress(v *RequestProgress) *SelectObjectContentInput {
|
|
s.RequestProgress = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentInput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *SelectObjectContentInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKey sets the SSECustomerKey field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentInput) SetSSECustomerKey(v string) *SelectObjectContentInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKey = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentInput) getSSECustomerKey() (v string) {
|
|
if s.SSECustomerKey == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.SSECustomerKey
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentInput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *SelectObjectContentInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type SelectObjectContentOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"Payload"`
|
|
|
|
// Use EventStream to use the API's stream.
|
|
EventStream *SelectObjectContentEventStream `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SelectObjectContentOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SelectObjectContentOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEventStream sets the EventStream field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentOutput) SetEventStream(v *SelectObjectContentEventStream) *SelectObjectContentOutput {
|
|
s.EventStream = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *SelectObjectContentOutput) runEventStreamLoop(r *request.Request) {
|
|
if r.Error != nil {
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
reader := newReadSelectObjectContentEventStream(
|
|
r.HTTPResponse.Body,
|
|
r.Handlers.UnmarshalStream,
|
|
r.Config.Logger,
|
|
r.Config.LogLevel.Value(),
|
|
)
|
|
go reader.readEventStream()
|
|
|
|
eventStream := &SelectObjectContentEventStream{
|
|
StreamCloser: r.HTTPResponse.Body,
|
|
Reader: reader,
|
|
}
|
|
s.EventStream = eventStream
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Describes the parameters for Select job types.
|
|
type SelectParameters struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The expression that is used to query the object.
|
|
//
|
|
// Expression is a required field
|
|
Expression *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The type of the provided expression (e.g., SQL).
|
|
//
|
|
// ExpressionType is a required field
|
|
ExpressionType *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"ExpressionType"`
|
|
|
|
// Describes the serialization format of the object.
|
|
//
|
|
// InputSerialization is a required field
|
|
InputSerialization *InputSerialization `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Describes how the results of the Select job are serialized.
|
|
//
|
|
// OutputSerialization is a required field
|
|
OutputSerialization *OutputSerialization `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SelectParameters) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SelectParameters) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *SelectParameters) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "SelectParameters"}
|
|
if s.Expression == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Expression"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ExpressionType == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ExpressionType"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputSerialization == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputSerialization"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OutputSerialization == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OutputSerialization"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpression sets the Expression field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectParameters) SetExpression(v string) *SelectParameters {
|
|
s.Expression = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExpressionType sets the ExpressionType field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectParameters) SetExpressionType(v string) *SelectParameters {
|
|
s.ExpressionType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSerialization sets the InputSerialization field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectParameters) SetInputSerialization(v *InputSerialization) *SelectParameters {
|
|
s.InputSerialization = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputSerialization sets the OutputSerialization field's value.
|
|
func (s *SelectParameters) SetOutputSerialization(v *OutputSerialization) *SelectParameters {
|
|
s.OutputSerialization = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Describes the default server-side encryption to apply to new objects in the
|
|
// bucket. If Put Object request does not specify any server-side encryption,
|
|
// this default encryption will be applied.
|
|
type ServerSideEncryptionByDefault struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// KMS master key ID to use for the default encryption. This parameter is allowed
|
|
// if SSEAlgorithm is aws:kms.
|
|
KMSMasterKeyID *string `type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Server-side encryption algorithm to use for the default encryption.
|
|
//
|
|
// SSEAlgorithm is a required field
|
|
SSEAlgorithm *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"ServerSideEncryption"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ServerSideEncryptionByDefault) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ServerSideEncryptionByDefault) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ServerSideEncryptionByDefault) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ServerSideEncryptionByDefault"}
|
|
if s.SSEAlgorithm == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SSEAlgorithm"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKMSMasterKeyID sets the KMSMasterKeyID field's value.
|
|
func (s *ServerSideEncryptionByDefault) SetKMSMasterKeyID(v string) *ServerSideEncryptionByDefault {
|
|
s.KMSMasterKeyID = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSEAlgorithm sets the SSEAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *ServerSideEncryptionByDefault) SetSSEAlgorithm(v string) *ServerSideEncryptionByDefault {
|
|
s.SSEAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Container for server-side encryption configuration rules. Currently S3 supports
|
|
// one rule only.
|
|
type ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Container for information about a particular server-side encryption configuration
|
|
// rule.
|
|
//
|
|
// Rules is a required field
|
|
Rules []*ServerSideEncryptionRule `locationName:"Rule" type:"list" flattened:"true" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.Rules == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Rules"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Rules != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Rules {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Rules", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRules sets the Rules field's value.
|
|
func (s *ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration) SetRules(v []*ServerSideEncryptionRule) *ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration {
|
|
s.Rules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Container for information about a particular server-side encryption configuration
|
|
// rule.
|
|
type ServerSideEncryptionRule struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Describes the default server-side encryption to apply to new objects in the
|
|
// bucket. If Put Object request does not specify any server-side encryption,
|
|
// this default encryption will be applied.
|
|
ApplyServerSideEncryptionByDefault *ServerSideEncryptionByDefault `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ServerSideEncryptionRule) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ServerSideEncryptionRule) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ServerSideEncryptionRule) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ServerSideEncryptionRule"}
|
|
if s.ApplyServerSideEncryptionByDefault != nil {
|
|
if err := s.ApplyServerSideEncryptionByDefault.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("ApplyServerSideEncryptionByDefault", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetApplyServerSideEncryptionByDefault sets the ApplyServerSideEncryptionByDefault field's value.
|
|
func (s *ServerSideEncryptionRule) SetApplyServerSideEncryptionByDefault(v *ServerSideEncryptionByDefault) *ServerSideEncryptionRule {
|
|
s.ApplyServerSideEncryptionByDefault = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for filters that define which source objects should be replicated.
|
|
type SourceSelectionCriteria struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for filter information for the selection of S3 objects encrypted
|
|
// with AWS KMS. If you include SourceSelectionCriteria in the replication configuration,
|
|
// this element is required.
|
|
SseKmsEncryptedObjects *SseKmsEncryptedObjects `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SourceSelectionCriteria) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SourceSelectionCriteria) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *SourceSelectionCriteria) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "SourceSelectionCriteria"}
|
|
if s.SseKmsEncryptedObjects != nil {
|
|
if err := s.SseKmsEncryptedObjects.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("SseKmsEncryptedObjects", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSseKmsEncryptedObjects sets the SseKmsEncryptedObjects field's value.
|
|
func (s *SourceSelectionCriteria) SetSseKmsEncryptedObjects(v *SseKmsEncryptedObjects) *SourceSelectionCriteria {
|
|
s.SseKmsEncryptedObjects = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for filter information for the selection of S3 objects encrypted
|
|
// with AWS KMS.
|
|
type SseKmsEncryptedObjects struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If the status is not Enabled, replication for S3 objects encrypted with AWS
|
|
// KMS is disabled.
|
|
//
|
|
// Status is a required field
|
|
Status *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"SseKmsEncryptedObjectsStatus"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SseKmsEncryptedObjects) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SseKmsEncryptedObjects) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *SseKmsEncryptedObjects) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "SseKmsEncryptedObjects"}
|
|
if s.Status == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Status"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
|
|
func (s *SseKmsEncryptedObjects) SetStatus(v string) *SseKmsEncryptedObjects {
|
|
s.Status = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Stats struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The total number of uncompressed object bytes processed.
|
|
BytesProcessed *int64 `type:"long"`
|
|
|
|
// The total number of bytes of records payload data returned.
|
|
BytesReturned *int64 `type:"long"`
|
|
|
|
// The total number of object bytes scanned.
|
|
BytesScanned *int64 `type:"long"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Stats) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Stats) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBytesProcessed sets the BytesProcessed field's value.
|
|
func (s *Stats) SetBytesProcessed(v int64) *Stats {
|
|
s.BytesProcessed = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBytesReturned sets the BytesReturned field's value.
|
|
func (s *Stats) SetBytesReturned(v int64) *Stats {
|
|
s.BytesReturned = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBytesScanned sets the BytesScanned field's value.
|
|
func (s *Stats) SetBytesScanned(v int64) *Stats {
|
|
s.BytesScanned = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StatsEvent struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `locationName:"StatsEvent" type:"structure" payload:"Details"`
|
|
|
|
// The Stats event details.
|
|
Details *Stats `locationName:"Details" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StatsEvent) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StatsEvent) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDetails sets the Details field's value.
|
|
func (s *StatsEvent) SetDetails(v *Stats) *StatsEvent {
|
|
s.Details = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The StatsEvent is and event in the SelectObjectContentEventStream group of events.
|
|
func (s *StatsEvent) eventSelectObjectContentEventStream() {}
|
|
|
|
// UnmarshalEvent unmarshals the EventStream Message into the StatsEvent value.
|
|
// This method is only used internally within the SDK's EventStream handling.
|
|
func (s *StatsEvent) UnmarshalEvent(
|
|
payloadUnmarshaler protocol.PayloadUnmarshaler,
|
|
msg eventstream.Message,
|
|
) error {
|
|
if err := payloadUnmarshaler.UnmarshalPayload(
|
|
bytes.NewReader(msg.Payload), s,
|
|
); err != nil {
|
|
return err
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StorageClassAnalysis struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A container used to describe how data related to the storage class analysis
|
|
// should be exported.
|
|
DataExport *StorageClassAnalysisDataExport `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StorageClassAnalysis) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StorageClassAnalysis) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StorageClassAnalysis) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StorageClassAnalysis"}
|
|
if s.DataExport != nil {
|
|
if err := s.DataExport.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("DataExport", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDataExport sets the DataExport field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageClassAnalysis) SetDataExport(v *StorageClassAnalysisDataExport) *StorageClassAnalysis {
|
|
s.DataExport = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StorageClassAnalysisDataExport struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The place to store the data for an analysis.
|
|
//
|
|
// Destination is a required field
|
|
Destination *AnalyticsExportDestination `type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The version of the output schema to use when exporting data. Must be V_1.
|
|
//
|
|
// OutputSchemaVersion is a required field
|
|
OutputSchemaVersion *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"StorageClassAnalysisSchemaVersion"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StorageClassAnalysisDataExport) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StorageClassAnalysisDataExport) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StorageClassAnalysisDataExport) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StorageClassAnalysisDataExport"}
|
|
if s.Destination == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OutputSchemaVersion == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OutputSchemaVersion"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Destination != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Destination.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Destination", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestination sets the Destination field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageClassAnalysisDataExport) SetDestination(v *AnalyticsExportDestination) *StorageClassAnalysisDataExport {
|
|
s.Destination = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputSchemaVersion sets the OutputSchemaVersion field's value.
|
|
func (s *StorageClassAnalysisDataExport) SetOutputSchemaVersion(v string) *StorageClassAnalysisDataExport {
|
|
s.OutputSchemaVersion = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Tag struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the tag.
|
|
//
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Value of the tag.
|
|
//
|
|
// Value is a required field
|
|
Value *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Tag) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Tag) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Tag) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Tag"}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Value == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Value"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *Tag) SetKey(v string) *Tag {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetValue sets the Value field's value.
|
|
func (s *Tag) SetValue(v string) *Tag {
|
|
s.Value = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Tagging struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// TagSet is a required field
|
|
TagSet []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Tagging) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Tagging) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Tagging) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Tagging"}
|
|
if s.TagSet == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TagSet"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TagSet != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.TagSet {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "TagSet", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTagSet sets the TagSet field's value.
|
|
func (s *Tagging) SetTagSet(v []*Tag) *Tagging {
|
|
s.TagSet = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type TargetGrant struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Grantee *Grantee `type:"structure" xmlPrefix:"xsi" xmlURI:"http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance"`
|
|
|
|
// Logging permissions assigned to the Grantee for the bucket.
|
|
Permission *string `type:"string" enum:"BucketLogsPermission"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TargetGrant) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TargetGrant) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *TargetGrant) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "TargetGrant"}
|
|
if s.Grantee != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Grantee.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Grantee", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGrantee sets the Grantee field's value.
|
|
func (s *TargetGrant) SetGrantee(v *Grantee) *TargetGrant {
|
|
s.Grantee = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPermission sets the Permission field's value.
|
|
func (s *TargetGrant) SetPermission(v string) *TargetGrant {
|
|
s.Permission = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A container for specifying the configuration for publication of messages
|
|
// to an Amazon Simple Notification Service (Amazon SNS) topic.when Amazon S3
|
|
// detects specified events.
|
|
type TopicConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Events is a required field
|
|
Events []*string `locationName:"Event" type:"list" flattened:"true" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// A container for object key name filtering rules. For information about key
|
|
// name filtering, see Configuring Event Notifications (https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/NotificationHowTo.html)
|
|
// in the Amazon Simple Storage Service Developer Guide.
|
|
Filter *NotificationConfigurationFilter `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An optional unique identifier for configurations in a notification configuration.
|
|
// If you don't provide one, Amazon S3 will assign an ID.
|
|
Id *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the Amazon SNS topic to which Amazon S3
|
|
// will publish a message when it detects events of the specified type.
|
|
//
|
|
// TopicArn is a required field
|
|
TopicArn *string `locationName:"Topic" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TopicConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TopicConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *TopicConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "TopicConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.Events == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Events"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TopicArn == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TopicArn"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEvents sets the Events field's value.
|
|
func (s *TopicConfiguration) SetEvents(v []*string) *TopicConfiguration {
|
|
s.Events = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilter sets the Filter field's value.
|
|
func (s *TopicConfiguration) SetFilter(v *NotificationConfigurationFilter) *TopicConfiguration {
|
|
s.Filter = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *TopicConfiguration) SetId(v string) *TopicConfiguration {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTopicArn sets the TopicArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *TopicConfiguration) SetTopicArn(v string) *TopicConfiguration {
|
|
s.TopicArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type TopicConfigurationDeprecated struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket event for which to send notifications.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deprecated: Event has been deprecated
|
|
Event *string `deprecated:"true" type:"string" enum:"Event"`
|
|
|
|
Events []*string `locationName:"Event" type:"list" flattened:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// An optional unique identifier for configurations in a notification configuration.
|
|
// If you don't provide one, Amazon S3 will assign an ID.
|
|
Id *string `type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Amazon SNS topic to which Amazon S3 will publish a message to report the
|
|
// specified events for the bucket.
|
|
Topic *string `type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TopicConfigurationDeprecated) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TopicConfigurationDeprecated) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEvent sets the Event field's value.
|
|
func (s *TopicConfigurationDeprecated) SetEvent(v string) *TopicConfigurationDeprecated {
|
|
s.Event = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEvents sets the Events field's value.
|
|
func (s *TopicConfigurationDeprecated) SetEvents(v []*string) *TopicConfigurationDeprecated {
|
|
s.Events = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *TopicConfigurationDeprecated) SetId(v string) *TopicConfigurationDeprecated {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTopic sets the Topic field's value.
|
|
func (s *TopicConfigurationDeprecated) SetTopic(v string) *TopicConfigurationDeprecated {
|
|
s.Topic = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Transition struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates at what date the object is to be moved or deleted. Should be in
|
|
// GMT ISO 8601 Format.
|
|
Date *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates the lifetime, in days, of the objects that are subject to the rule.
|
|
// The value must be a non-zero positive integer.
|
|
Days *int64 `type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The class of storage used to store the object.
|
|
StorageClass *string `type:"string" enum:"TransitionStorageClass"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Transition) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Transition) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDate sets the Date field's value.
|
|
func (s *Transition) SetDate(v time.Time) *Transition {
|
|
s.Date = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDays sets the Days field's value.
|
|
func (s *Transition) SetDays(v int64) *Transition {
|
|
s.Days = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStorageClass sets the StorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *Transition) SetStorageClass(v string) *Transition {
|
|
s.StorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UploadPartCopyInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the source bucket and key name of the source object, separated
|
|
// by a slash (/). Must be URL-encoded.
|
|
//
|
|
// CopySource is a required field
|
|
CopySource *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Copies the object if its entity tag (ETag) matches the specified tag.
|
|
CopySourceIfMatch *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-if-match" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Copies the object if it has been modified since the specified time.
|
|
CopySourceIfModifiedSince *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-if-modified-since" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// Copies the object if its entity tag (ETag) is different than the specified
|
|
// ETag.
|
|
CopySourceIfNoneMatch *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-if-none-match" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Copies the object if it hasn't been modified since the specified time.
|
|
CopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince *time.Time `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-if-unmodified-since" type:"timestamp"`
|
|
|
|
// The range of bytes to copy from the source object. The range value must use
|
|
// the form bytes=first-last, where the first and last are the zero-based byte
|
|
// offsets to copy. For example, bytes=0-9 indicates that you want to copy the
|
|
// first ten bytes of the source. You can copy a range only if the source object
|
|
// is greater than 5 MB.
|
|
CopySourceRange *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-range" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the algorithm to use when decrypting the source object (e.g., AES256).
|
|
CopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use to decrypt
|
|
// the source object. The encryption key provided in this header must be one
|
|
// that was used when the source object was created.
|
|
CopySourceSSECustomerKey *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-server-side-encryption-customer-key" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321.
|
|
// Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure the encryption
|
|
// key was transmitted without error.
|
|
CopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Part number of part being copied. This is a positive integer between 1 and
|
|
// 10,000.
|
|
//
|
|
// PartNumber is a required field
|
|
PartNumber *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"partNumber" type:"integer" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the algorithm to use to when encrypting the object (e.g., AES256).
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting
|
|
// data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded; Amazon
|
|
// does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with
|
|
// the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm
|
|
// header. This must be the same encryption key specified in the initiate multipart
|
|
// upload request.
|
|
SSECustomerKey *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321.
|
|
// Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure the encryption
|
|
// key was transmitted without error.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Upload ID identifying the multipart upload whose part is being copied.
|
|
//
|
|
// UploadId is a required field
|
|
UploadId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"uploadId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UploadPartCopyInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UploadPartCopyInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UploadPartCopyInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CopySource == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CopySource"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartNumber == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PartNumber"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.UploadId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UploadId"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetBucket(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySource sets the CopySource field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetCopySource(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.CopySource = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceIfMatch sets the CopySourceIfMatch field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetCopySourceIfMatch(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceIfMatch = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceIfModifiedSince sets the CopySourceIfModifiedSince field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetCopySourceIfModifiedSince(v time.Time) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceIfModifiedSince = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceIfNoneMatch sets the CopySourceIfNoneMatch field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetCopySourceIfNoneMatch(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceIfNoneMatch = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince sets the CopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetCopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince(v time.Time) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceRange sets the CopySourceRange field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetCopySourceRange(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceRange = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the CopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetCopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceSSECustomerKey sets the CopySourceSSECustomerKey field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetCopySourceSSECustomerKey(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceSSECustomerKey = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) getCopySourceSSECustomerKey() (v string) {
|
|
if s.CopySourceSSECustomerKey == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.CopySourceSSECustomerKey
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the CopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetCopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.CopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetKey(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartNumber sets the PartNumber field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetPartNumber(v int64) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.PartNumber = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKey sets the SSECustomerKey field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetSSECustomerKey(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKey = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) getSSECustomerKey() (v string) {
|
|
if s.SSECustomerKey == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.SSECustomerKey
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUploadId sets the UploadId field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyInput) SetUploadId(v string) *UploadPartCopyInput {
|
|
s.UploadId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UploadPartCopyOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"CopyPartResult"`
|
|
|
|
CopyPartResult *CopyPartResult `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The version of the source object that was copied, if you have enabled versioning
|
|
// on the source bucket.
|
|
CopySourceVersionId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-copy-source-version-id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header confirming the encryption algorithm
|
|
// used.
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header to provide round trip message integrity
|
|
// verification of the customer-provided encryption key.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, specifies the ID of the AWS Key Management Service (KMS) master
|
|
// encryption key that was used for the object.
|
|
SSEKMSKeyId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The Server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
|
|
// (e.g., AES256, aws:kms).
|
|
ServerSideEncryption *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption" type:"string" enum:"ServerSideEncryption"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UploadPartCopyOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UploadPartCopyOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopyPartResult sets the CopyPartResult field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyOutput) SetCopyPartResult(v *CopyPartResult) *UploadPartCopyOutput {
|
|
s.CopyPartResult = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCopySourceVersionId sets the CopySourceVersionId field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyOutput) SetCopySourceVersionId(v string) *UploadPartCopyOutput {
|
|
s.CopySourceVersionId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *UploadPartCopyOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyOutput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *UploadPartCopyOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyOutput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *UploadPartCopyOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSEKMSKeyId sets the SSEKMSKeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyOutput) SetSSEKMSKeyId(v string) *UploadPartCopyOutput {
|
|
s.SSEKMSKeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerSideEncryption sets the ServerSideEncryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartCopyOutput) SetServerSideEncryption(v string) *UploadPartCopyOutput {
|
|
s.ServerSideEncryption = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UploadPartInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure" payload:"Body"`
|
|
|
|
// Object data.
|
|
Body io.ReadSeeker `type:"blob"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the bucket to which the multipart upload was initiated.
|
|
//
|
|
// Bucket is a required field
|
|
Bucket *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Bucket" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Size of the body in bytes. This parameter is useful when the size of the
|
|
// body cannot be determined automatically.
|
|
ContentLength *int64 `location:"header" locationName:"Content-Length" type:"long"`
|
|
|
|
// The base64-encoded 128-bit MD5 digest of the part data.
|
|
ContentMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"Content-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Object key for which the multipart upload was initiated.
|
|
//
|
|
// Key is a required field
|
|
Key *string `location:"uri" locationName:"Key" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Part number of part being uploaded. This is a positive integer between 1
|
|
// and 10,000.
|
|
//
|
|
// PartNumber is a required field
|
|
PartNumber *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"partNumber" type:"integer" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
RequestPayer *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-payer" type:"string" enum:"RequestPayer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the algorithm to use to when encrypting the object (e.g., AES256).
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting
|
|
// data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded; Amazon
|
|
// does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with
|
|
// the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm
|
|
// header. This must be the same encryption key specified in the initiate multipart
|
|
// upload request.
|
|
SSECustomerKey *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321.
|
|
// Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure the encryption
|
|
// key was transmitted without error.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Upload ID identifying the multipart upload whose part is being uploaded.
|
|
//
|
|
// UploadId is a required field
|
|
UploadId *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"uploadId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UploadPartInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UploadPartInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UploadPartInput"}
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Bucket"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Bucket != nil && len(*s.Bucket) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Bucket", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Key"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Key != nil && len(*s.Key) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Key", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.PartNumber == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("PartNumber"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.UploadId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("UploadId"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBody sets the Body field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) SetBody(v io.ReadSeeker) *UploadPartInput {
|
|
s.Body = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBucket sets the Bucket field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) SetBucket(v string) *UploadPartInput {
|
|
s.Bucket = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) getBucket() (v string) {
|
|
if s.Bucket == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.Bucket
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentLength sets the ContentLength field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) SetContentLength(v int64) *UploadPartInput {
|
|
s.ContentLength = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContentMD5 sets the ContentMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) SetContentMD5(v string) *UploadPartInput {
|
|
s.ContentMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKey sets the Key field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) SetKey(v string) *UploadPartInput {
|
|
s.Key = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPartNumber sets the PartNumber field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) SetPartNumber(v int64) *UploadPartInput {
|
|
s.PartNumber = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestPayer sets the RequestPayer field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) SetRequestPayer(v string) *UploadPartInput {
|
|
s.RequestPayer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *UploadPartInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKey sets the SSECustomerKey field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) SetSSECustomerKey(v string) *UploadPartInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKey = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) getSSECustomerKey() (v string) {
|
|
if s.SSECustomerKey == nil {
|
|
return v
|
|
}
|
|
return *s.SSECustomerKey
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *UploadPartInput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUploadId sets the UploadId field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartInput) SetUploadId(v string) *UploadPartInput {
|
|
s.UploadId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UploadPartOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Entity tag for the uploaded object.
|
|
ETag *string `location:"header" locationName:"ETag" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
RequestCharged *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-request-charged" type:"string" enum:"RequestCharged"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header confirming the encryption algorithm
|
|
// used.
|
|
SSECustomerAlgorithm *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested,
|
|
// the response will include this header to provide round trip message integrity
|
|
// verification of the customer-provided encryption key.
|
|
SSECustomerKeyMD5 *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If present, specifies the ID of the AWS Key Management Service (KMS) master
|
|
// encryption key that was used for the object.
|
|
SSEKMSKeyId *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" type:"string" sensitive:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The Server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3
|
|
// (e.g., AES256, aws:kms).
|
|
ServerSideEncryption *string `location:"header" locationName:"x-amz-server-side-encryption" type:"string" enum:"ServerSideEncryption"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UploadPartOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UploadPartOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetETag sets the ETag field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartOutput) SetETag(v string) *UploadPartOutput {
|
|
s.ETag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestCharged sets the RequestCharged field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartOutput) SetRequestCharged(v string) *UploadPartOutput {
|
|
s.RequestCharged = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerAlgorithm sets the SSECustomerAlgorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartOutput) SetSSECustomerAlgorithm(v string) *UploadPartOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerAlgorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSECustomerKeyMD5 sets the SSECustomerKeyMD5 field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartOutput) SetSSECustomerKeyMD5(v string) *UploadPartOutput {
|
|
s.SSECustomerKeyMD5 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSSEKMSKeyId sets the SSEKMSKeyId field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartOutput) SetSSEKMSKeyId(v string) *UploadPartOutput {
|
|
s.SSEKMSKeyId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerSideEncryption sets the ServerSideEncryption field's value.
|
|
func (s *UploadPartOutput) SetServerSideEncryption(v string) *UploadPartOutput {
|
|
s.ServerSideEncryption = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type VersioningConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether MFA delete is enabled in the bucket versioning configuration.
|
|
// This element is only returned if the bucket has been configured with MFA
|
|
// delete. If the bucket has never been so configured, this element is not returned.
|
|
MFADelete *string `locationName:"MfaDelete" type:"string" enum:"MFADelete"`
|
|
|
|
// The versioning state of the bucket.
|
|
Status *string `type:"string" enum:"BucketVersioningStatus"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VersioningConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VersioningConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMFADelete sets the MFADelete field's value.
|
|
func (s *VersioningConfiguration) SetMFADelete(v string) *VersioningConfiguration {
|
|
s.MFADelete = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStatus sets the Status field's value.
|
|
func (s *VersioningConfiguration) SetStatus(v string) *VersioningConfiguration {
|
|
s.Status = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type WebsiteConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
ErrorDocument *ErrorDocument `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
IndexDocument *IndexDocument `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
RedirectAllRequestsTo *RedirectAllRequestsTo `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
RoutingRules []*RoutingRule `locationNameList:"RoutingRule" type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s WebsiteConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s WebsiteConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *WebsiteConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "WebsiteConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.ErrorDocument != nil {
|
|
if err := s.ErrorDocument.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("ErrorDocument", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.IndexDocument != nil {
|
|
if err := s.IndexDocument.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("IndexDocument", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RedirectAllRequestsTo != nil {
|
|
if err := s.RedirectAllRequestsTo.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("RedirectAllRequestsTo", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RoutingRules != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.RoutingRules {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "RoutingRules", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrorDocument sets the ErrorDocument field's value.
|
|
func (s *WebsiteConfiguration) SetErrorDocument(v *ErrorDocument) *WebsiteConfiguration {
|
|
s.ErrorDocument = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIndexDocument sets the IndexDocument field's value.
|
|
func (s *WebsiteConfiguration) SetIndexDocument(v *IndexDocument) *WebsiteConfiguration {
|
|
s.IndexDocument = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRedirectAllRequestsTo sets the RedirectAllRequestsTo field's value.
|
|
func (s *WebsiteConfiguration) SetRedirectAllRequestsTo(v *RedirectAllRequestsTo) *WebsiteConfiguration {
|
|
s.RedirectAllRequestsTo = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoutingRules sets the RoutingRules field's value.
|
|
func (s *WebsiteConfiguration) SetRoutingRules(v []*RoutingRule) *WebsiteConfiguration {
|
|
s.RoutingRules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AnalyticsS3ExportFileFormatCsv is a AnalyticsS3ExportFileFormat enum value
|
|
AnalyticsS3ExportFileFormatCsv = "CSV"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// BucketAccelerateStatusEnabled is a BucketAccelerateStatus enum value
|
|
BucketAccelerateStatusEnabled = "Enabled"
|
|
|
|
// BucketAccelerateStatusSuspended is a BucketAccelerateStatus enum value
|
|
BucketAccelerateStatusSuspended = "Suspended"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// BucketCannedACLPrivate is a BucketCannedACL enum value
|
|
BucketCannedACLPrivate = "private"
|
|
|
|
// BucketCannedACLPublicRead is a BucketCannedACL enum value
|
|
BucketCannedACLPublicRead = "public-read"
|
|
|
|
// BucketCannedACLPublicReadWrite is a BucketCannedACL enum value
|
|
BucketCannedACLPublicReadWrite = "public-read-write"
|
|
|
|
// BucketCannedACLAuthenticatedRead is a BucketCannedACL enum value
|
|
BucketCannedACLAuthenticatedRead = "authenticated-read"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// BucketLocationConstraintEu is a BucketLocationConstraint enum value
|
|
BucketLocationConstraintEu = "EU"
|
|
|
|
// BucketLocationConstraintEuWest1 is a BucketLocationConstraint enum value
|
|
BucketLocationConstraintEuWest1 = "eu-west-1"
|
|
|
|
// BucketLocationConstraintUsWest1 is a BucketLocationConstraint enum value
|
|
BucketLocationConstraintUsWest1 = "us-west-1"
|
|
|
|
// BucketLocationConstraintUsWest2 is a BucketLocationConstraint enum value
|
|
BucketLocationConstraintUsWest2 = "us-west-2"
|
|
|
|
// BucketLocationConstraintApSouth1 is a BucketLocationConstraint enum value
|
|
BucketLocationConstraintApSouth1 = "ap-south-1"
|
|
|
|
// BucketLocationConstraintApSoutheast1 is a BucketLocationConstraint enum value
|
|
BucketLocationConstraintApSoutheast1 = "ap-southeast-1"
|
|
|
|
// BucketLocationConstraintApSoutheast2 is a BucketLocationConstraint enum value
|
|
BucketLocationConstraintApSoutheast2 = "ap-southeast-2"
|
|
|
|
// BucketLocationConstraintApNortheast1 is a BucketLocationConstraint enum value
|
|
BucketLocationConstraintApNortheast1 = "ap-northeast-1"
|
|
|
|
// BucketLocationConstraintSaEast1 is a BucketLocationConstraint enum value
|
|
BucketLocationConstraintSaEast1 = "sa-east-1"
|
|
|
|
// BucketLocationConstraintCnNorth1 is a BucketLocationConstraint enum value
|
|
BucketLocationConstraintCnNorth1 = "cn-north-1"
|
|
|
|
// BucketLocationConstraintEuCentral1 is a BucketLocationConstraint enum value
|
|
BucketLocationConstraintEuCentral1 = "eu-central-1"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// BucketLogsPermissionFullControl is a BucketLogsPermission enum value
|
|
BucketLogsPermissionFullControl = "FULL_CONTROL"
|
|
|
|
// BucketLogsPermissionRead is a BucketLogsPermission enum value
|
|
BucketLogsPermissionRead = "READ"
|
|
|
|
// BucketLogsPermissionWrite is a BucketLogsPermission enum value
|
|
BucketLogsPermissionWrite = "WRITE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// BucketVersioningStatusEnabled is a BucketVersioningStatus enum value
|
|
BucketVersioningStatusEnabled = "Enabled"
|
|
|
|
// BucketVersioningStatusSuspended is a BucketVersioningStatus enum value
|
|
BucketVersioningStatusSuspended = "Suspended"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// CompressionTypeNone is a CompressionType enum value
|
|
CompressionTypeNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// CompressionTypeGzip is a CompressionType enum value
|
|
CompressionTypeGzip = "GZIP"
|
|
|
|
// CompressionTypeBzip2 is a CompressionType enum value
|
|
CompressionTypeBzip2 = "BZIP2"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// DeleteMarkerReplicationStatusEnabled is a DeleteMarkerReplicationStatus enum value
|
|
DeleteMarkerReplicationStatusEnabled = "Enabled"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteMarkerReplicationStatusDisabled is a DeleteMarkerReplicationStatus enum value
|
|
DeleteMarkerReplicationStatusDisabled = "Disabled"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Requests Amazon S3 to encode the object keys in the response and specifies
|
|
// the encoding method to use. An object key may contain any Unicode character;
|
|
// however, XML 1.0 parser cannot parse some characters, such as characters
|
|
// with an ASCII value from 0 to 10. For characters that are not supported in
|
|
// XML 1.0, you can add this parameter to request that Amazon S3 encode the
|
|
// keys in the response.
|
|
const (
|
|
// EncodingTypeUrl is a EncodingType enum value
|
|
EncodingTypeUrl = "url"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// The bucket event for which to send notifications.
|
|
const (
|
|
// EventS3ReducedRedundancyLostObject is a Event enum value
|
|
EventS3ReducedRedundancyLostObject = "s3:ReducedRedundancyLostObject"
|
|
|
|
// EventS3ObjectCreated is a Event enum value
|
|
EventS3ObjectCreated = "s3:ObjectCreated:*"
|
|
|
|
// EventS3ObjectCreatedPut is a Event enum value
|
|
EventS3ObjectCreatedPut = "s3:ObjectCreated:Put"
|
|
|
|
// EventS3ObjectCreatedPost is a Event enum value
|
|
EventS3ObjectCreatedPost = "s3:ObjectCreated:Post"
|
|
|
|
// EventS3ObjectCreatedCopy is a Event enum value
|
|
EventS3ObjectCreatedCopy = "s3:ObjectCreated:Copy"
|
|
|
|
// EventS3ObjectCreatedCompleteMultipartUpload is a Event enum value
|
|
EventS3ObjectCreatedCompleteMultipartUpload = "s3:ObjectCreated:CompleteMultipartUpload"
|
|
|
|
// EventS3ObjectRemoved is a Event enum value
|
|
EventS3ObjectRemoved = "s3:ObjectRemoved:*"
|
|
|
|
// EventS3ObjectRemovedDelete is a Event enum value
|
|
EventS3ObjectRemovedDelete = "s3:ObjectRemoved:Delete"
|
|
|
|
// EventS3ObjectRemovedDeleteMarkerCreated is a Event enum value
|
|
EventS3ObjectRemovedDeleteMarkerCreated = "s3:ObjectRemoved:DeleteMarkerCreated"
|
|
|
|
// EventS3ObjectRestorePost is a Event enum value
|
|
EventS3ObjectRestorePost = "s3:ObjectRestore:Post"
|
|
|
|
// EventS3ObjectRestoreCompleted is a Event enum value
|
|
EventS3ObjectRestoreCompleted = "s3:ObjectRestore:Completed"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ExpirationStatusEnabled is a ExpirationStatus enum value
|
|
ExpirationStatusEnabled = "Enabled"
|
|
|
|
// ExpirationStatusDisabled is a ExpirationStatus enum value
|
|
ExpirationStatusDisabled = "Disabled"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ExpressionTypeSql is a ExpressionType enum value
|
|
ExpressionTypeSql = "SQL"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// FileHeaderInfoUse is a FileHeaderInfo enum value
|
|
FileHeaderInfoUse = "USE"
|
|
|
|
// FileHeaderInfoIgnore is a FileHeaderInfo enum value
|
|
FileHeaderInfoIgnore = "IGNORE"
|
|
|
|
// FileHeaderInfoNone is a FileHeaderInfo enum value
|
|
FileHeaderInfoNone = "NONE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// FilterRuleNamePrefix is a FilterRuleName enum value
|
|
FilterRuleNamePrefix = "prefix"
|
|
|
|
// FilterRuleNameSuffix is a FilterRuleName enum value
|
|
FilterRuleNameSuffix = "suffix"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InventoryFormatCsv is a InventoryFormat enum value
|
|
InventoryFormatCsv = "CSV"
|
|
|
|
// InventoryFormatOrc is a InventoryFormat enum value
|
|
InventoryFormatOrc = "ORC"
|
|
|
|
// InventoryFormatParquet is a InventoryFormat enum value
|
|
InventoryFormatParquet = "Parquet"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InventoryFrequencyDaily is a InventoryFrequency enum value
|
|
InventoryFrequencyDaily = "Daily"
|
|
|
|
// InventoryFrequencyWeekly is a InventoryFrequency enum value
|
|
InventoryFrequencyWeekly = "Weekly"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InventoryIncludedObjectVersionsAll is a InventoryIncludedObjectVersions enum value
|
|
InventoryIncludedObjectVersionsAll = "All"
|
|
|
|
// InventoryIncludedObjectVersionsCurrent is a InventoryIncludedObjectVersions enum value
|
|
InventoryIncludedObjectVersionsCurrent = "Current"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InventoryOptionalFieldSize is a InventoryOptionalField enum value
|
|
InventoryOptionalFieldSize = "Size"
|
|
|
|
// InventoryOptionalFieldLastModifiedDate is a InventoryOptionalField enum value
|
|
InventoryOptionalFieldLastModifiedDate = "LastModifiedDate"
|
|
|
|
// InventoryOptionalFieldStorageClass is a InventoryOptionalField enum value
|
|
InventoryOptionalFieldStorageClass = "StorageClass"
|
|
|
|
// InventoryOptionalFieldEtag is a InventoryOptionalField enum value
|
|
InventoryOptionalFieldEtag = "ETag"
|
|
|
|
// InventoryOptionalFieldIsMultipartUploaded is a InventoryOptionalField enum value
|
|
InventoryOptionalFieldIsMultipartUploaded = "IsMultipartUploaded"
|
|
|
|
// InventoryOptionalFieldReplicationStatus is a InventoryOptionalField enum value
|
|
InventoryOptionalFieldReplicationStatus = "ReplicationStatus"
|
|
|
|
// InventoryOptionalFieldEncryptionStatus is a InventoryOptionalField enum value
|
|
InventoryOptionalFieldEncryptionStatus = "EncryptionStatus"
|
|
|
|
// InventoryOptionalFieldObjectLockRetainUntilDate is a InventoryOptionalField enum value
|
|
InventoryOptionalFieldObjectLockRetainUntilDate = "ObjectLockRetainUntilDate"
|
|
|
|
// InventoryOptionalFieldObjectLockMode is a InventoryOptionalField enum value
|
|
InventoryOptionalFieldObjectLockMode = "ObjectLockMode"
|
|
|
|
// InventoryOptionalFieldObjectLockLegalHoldStatus is a InventoryOptionalField enum value
|
|
InventoryOptionalFieldObjectLockLegalHoldStatus = "ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// JSONTypeDocument is a JSONType enum value
|
|
JSONTypeDocument = "DOCUMENT"
|
|
|
|
// JSONTypeLines is a JSONType enum value
|
|
JSONTypeLines = "LINES"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// MFADeleteEnabled is a MFADelete enum value
|
|
MFADeleteEnabled = "Enabled"
|
|
|
|
// MFADeleteDisabled is a MFADelete enum value
|
|
MFADeleteDisabled = "Disabled"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// MFADeleteStatusEnabled is a MFADeleteStatus enum value
|
|
MFADeleteStatusEnabled = "Enabled"
|
|
|
|
// MFADeleteStatusDisabled is a MFADeleteStatus enum value
|
|
MFADeleteStatusDisabled = "Disabled"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// MetadataDirectiveCopy is a MetadataDirective enum value
|
|
MetadataDirectiveCopy = "COPY"
|
|
|
|
// MetadataDirectiveReplace is a MetadataDirective enum value
|
|
MetadataDirectiveReplace = "REPLACE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ObjectCannedACLPrivate is a ObjectCannedACL enum value
|
|
ObjectCannedACLPrivate = "private"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectCannedACLPublicRead is a ObjectCannedACL enum value
|
|
ObjectCannedACLPublicRead = "public-read"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectCannedACLPublicReadWrite is a ObjectCannedACL enum value
|
|
ObjectCannedACLPublicReadWrite = "public-read-write"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectCannedACLAuthenticatedRead is a ObjectCannedACL enum value
|
|
ObjectCannedACLAuthenticatedRead = "authenticated-read"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectCannedACLAwsExecRead is a ObjectCannedACL enum value
|
|
ObjectCannedACLAwsExecRead = "aws-exec-read"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectCannedACLBucketOwnerRead is a ObjectCannedACL enum value
|
|
ObjectCannedACLBucketOwnerRead = "bucket-owner-read"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectCannedACLBucketOwnerFullControl is a ObjectCannedACL enum value
|
|
ObjectCannedACLBucketOwnerFullControl = "bucket-owner-full-control"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ObjectLockEnabledEnabled is a ObjectLockEnabled enum value
|
|
ObjectLockEnabledEnabled = "Enabled"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ObjectLockLegalHoldStatusOn is a ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus enum value
|
|
ObjectLockLegalHoldStatusOn = "ON"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectLockLegalHoldStatusOff is a ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus enum value
|
|
ObjectLockLegalHoldStatusOff = "OFF"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ObjectLockModeGovernance is a ObjectLockMode enum value
|
|
ObjectLockModeGovernance = "GOVERNANCE"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectLockModeCompliance is a ObjectLockMode enum value
|
|
ObjectLockModeCompliance = "COMPLIANCE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ObjectLockRetentionModeGovernance is a ObjectLockRetentionMode enum value
|
|
ObjectLockRetentionModeGovernance = "GOVERNANCE"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectLockRetentionModeCompliance is a ObjectLockRetentionMode enum value
|
|
ObjectLockRetentionModeCompliance = "COMPLIANCE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ObjectStorageClassStandard is a ObjectStorageClass enum value
|
|
ObjectStorageClassStandard = "STANDARD"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectStorageClassReducedRedundancy is a ObjectStorageClass enum value
|
|
ObjectStorageClassReducedRedundancy = "REDUCED_REDUNDANCY"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectStorageClassGlacier is a ObjectStorageClass enum value
|
|
ObjectStorageClassGlacier = "GLACIER"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectStorageClassStandardIa is a ObjectStorageClass enum value
|
|
ObjectStorageClassStandardIa = "STANDARD_IA"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectStorageClassOnezoneIa is a ObjectStorageClass enum value
|
|
ObjectStorageClassOnezoneIa = "ONEZONE_IA"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectStorageClassIntelligentTiering is a ObjectStorageClass enum value
|
|
ObjectStorageClassIntelligentTiering = "INTELLIGENT_TIERING"
|
|
|
|
// ObjectStorageClassDeepArchive is a ObjectStorageClass enum value
|
|
ObjectStorageClassDeepArchive = "DEEP_ARCHIVE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ObjectVersionStorageClassStandard is a ObjectVersionStorageClass enum value
|
|
ObjectVersionStorageClassStandard = "STANDARD"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// OwnerOverrideDestination is a OwnerOverride enum value
|
|
OwnerOverrideDestination = "Destination"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// PayerRequester is a Payer enum value
|
|
PayerRequester = "Requester"
|
|
|
|
// PayerBucketOwner is a Payer enum value
|
|
PayerBucketOwner = "BucketOwner"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// PermissionFullControl is a Permission enum value
|
|
PermissionFullControl = "FULL_CONTROL"
|
|
|
|
// PermissionWrite is a Permission enum value
|
|
PermissionWrite = "WRITE"
|
|
|
|
// PermissionWriteAcp is a Permission enum value
|
|
PermissionWriteAcp = "WRITE_ACP"
|
|
|
|
// PermissionRead is a Permission enum value
|
|
PermissionRead = "READ"
|
|
|
|
// PermissionReadAcp is a Permission enum value
|
|
PermissionReadAcp = "READ_ACP"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ProtocolHttp is a Protocol enum value
|
|
ProtocolHttp = "http"
|
|
|
|
// ProtocolHttps is a Protocol enum value
|
|
ProtocolHttps = "https"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// QuoteFieldsAlways is a QuoteFields enum value
|
|
QuoteFieldsAlways = "ALWAYS"
|
|
|
|
// QuoteFieldsAsneeded is a QuoteFields enum value
|
|
QuoteFieldsAsneeded = "ASNEEDED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ReplicationRuleStatusEnabled is a ReplicationRuleStatus enum value
|
|
ReplicationRuleStatusEnabled = "Enabled"
|
|
|
|
// ReplicationRuleStatusDisabled is a ReplicationRuleStatus enum value
|
|
ReplicationRuleStatusDisabled = "Disabled"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ReplicationStatusComplete is a ReplicationStatus enum value
|
|
ReplicationStatusComplete = "COMPLETE"
|
|
|
|
// ReplicationStatusPending is a ReplicationStatus enum value
|
|
ReplicationStatusPending = "PENDING"
|
|
|
|
// ReplicationStatusFailed is a ReplicationStatus enum value
|
|
ReplicationStatusFailed = "FAILED"
|
|
|
|
// ReplicationStatusReplica is a ReplicationStatus enum value
|
|
ReplicationStatusReplica = "REPLICA"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the
|
|
// request.
|
|
const (
|
|
// RequestChargedRequester is a RequestCharged enum value
|
|
RequestChargedRequester = "requester"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the
|
|
// request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.
|
|
// Documentation on downloading objects from requester pays buckets can be found
|
|
// at http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/ObjectsinRequesterPaysBuckets.html
|
|
const (
|
|
// RequestPayerRequester is a RequestPayer enum value
|
|
RequestPayerRequester = "requester"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// RestoreRequestTypeSelect is a RestoreRequestType enum value
|
|
RestoreRequestTypeSelect = "SELECT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ServerSideEncryptionAes256 is a ServerSideEncryption enum value
|
|
ServerSideEncryptionAes256 = "AES256"
|
|
|
|
// ServerSideEncryptionAwsKms is a ServerSideEncryption enum value
|
|
ServerSideEncryptionAwsKms = "aws:kms"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// SseKmsEncryptedObjectsStatusEnabled is a SseKmsEncryptedObjectsStatus enum value
|
|
SseKmsEncryptedObjectsStatusEnabled = "Enabled"
|
|
|
|
// SseKmsEncryptedObjectsStatusDisabled is a SseKmsEncryptedObjectsStatus enum value
|
|
SseKmsEncryptedObjectsStatusDisabled = "Disabled"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// StorageClassStandard is a StorageClass enum value
|
|
StorageClassStandard = "STANDARD"
|
|
|
|
// StorageClassReducedRedundancy is a StorageClass enum value
|
|
StorageClassReducedRedundancy = "REDUCED_REDUNDANCY"
|
|
|
|
// StorageClassStandardIa is a StorageClass enum value
|
|
StorageClassStandardIa = "STANDARD_IA"
|
|
|
|
// StorageClassOnezoneIa is a StorageClass enum value
|
|
StorageClassOnezoneIa = "ONEZONE_IA"
|
|
|
|
// StorageClassIntelligentTiering is a StorageClass enum value
|
|
StorageClassIntelligentTiering = "INTELLIGENT_TIERING"
|
|
|
|
// StorageClassGlacier is a StorageClass enum value
|
|
StorageClassGlacier = "GLACIER"
|
|
|
|
// StorageClassDeepArchive is a StorageClass enum value
|
|
StorageClassDeepArchive = "DEEP_ARCHIVE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// StorageClassAnalysisSchemaVersionV1 is a StorageClassAnalysisSchemaVersion enum value
|
|
StorageClassAnalysisSchemaVersionV1 = "V_1"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// TaggingDirectiveCopy is a TaggingDirective enum value
|
|
TaggingDirectiveCopy = "COPY"
|
|
|
|
// TaggingDirectiveReplace is a TaggingDirective enum value
|
|
TaggingDirectiveReplace = "REPLACE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// TierStandard is a Tier enum value
|
|
TierStandard = "Standard"
|
|
|
|
// TierBulk is a Tier enum value
|
|
TierBulk = "Bulk"
|
|
|
|
// TierExpedited is a Tier enum value
|
|
TierExpedited = "Expedited"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// TransitionStorageClassGlacier is a TransitionStorageClass enum value
|
|
TransitionStorageClassGlacier = "GLACIER"
|
|
|
|
// TransitionStorageClassStandardIa is a TransitionStorageClass enum value
|
|
TransitionStorageClassStandardIa = "STANDARD_IA"
|
|
|
|
// TransitionStorageClassOnezoneIa is a TransitionStorageClass enum value
|
|
TransitionStorageClassOnezoneIa = "ONEZONE_IA"
|
|
|
|
// TransitionStorageClassIntelligentTiering is a TransitionStorageClass enum value
|
|
TransitionStorageClassIntelligentTiering = "INTELLIGENT_TIERING"
|
|
|
|
// TransitionStorageClassDeepArchive is a TransitionStorageClass enum value
|
|
TransitionStorageClassDeepArchive = "DEEP_ARCHIVE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// TypeCanonicalUser is a Type enum value
|
|
TypeCanonicalUser = "CanonicalUser"
|
|
|
|
// TypeAmazonCustomerByEmail is a Type enum value
|
|
TypeAmazonCustomerByEmail = "AmazonCustomerByEmail"
|
|
|
|
// TypeGroup is a Type enum value
|
|
TypeGroup = "Group"
|
|
)
|